blob: 17f88604063cd62d804ccbc7dfe5f01b8a05f4cf [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau15480d72014-06-19 21:10:58 +02005 version 1.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau9229f122014-06-19 21:01:06 +02007 2014/06/19
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900451 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200452 - gid
453 - group
454 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100455 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200456 - nbproc
457 - pidfile
458 - uid
459 - ulimit-n
460 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200461 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100462 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200463 - node
464 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100465 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100466
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200467 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200468 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200469 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200470 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100471 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100472 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100473 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200474 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200475 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200476 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200477 - noepoll
478 - nokqueue
479 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100480 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300481 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200482 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200483 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200484 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100485 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100486 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200487 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100488 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100489 - tune.maxaccept
490 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200491 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200492 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100493 - tune.rcvbuf.client
494 - tune.rcvbuf.server
495 - tune.sndbuf.client
496 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100497 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100498 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200499 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100500 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200501 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100502 - tune.zlib.memlevel
503 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100504
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200505 * Debugging
506 - debug
507 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200508
509
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005103.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200511------------------------------------
512
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200513ca-base <dir>
514 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200515 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
516 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200517
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200518chroot <jail dir>
519 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
520 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
521 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
522 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
523 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
524 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100525
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100526cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
527 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
528 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
529 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100530 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
531 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
532 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
533 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
534 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
535 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
536 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
537 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
538 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
539 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100540
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200541crt-base <dir>
542 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
543 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
544 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
545
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200546daemon
547 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
548 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
549 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
550
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900551external-check
552 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
553 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
554 See "option external-check".
555
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200556gid <number>
557 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
558 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
559 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100560 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
561 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200562 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100563
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200564group <group name>
565 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
566 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100567
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200568log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200569 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
570 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100571 configured with "log global".
572
573 <address> can be one of:
574
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100575 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100576 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
577 port).
578
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100579 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
580 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
581 port).
582
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100583 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
584 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
585 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
586 writeable).
587
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100588 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
589 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
590 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
591 in Bourne shell.
592
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200593 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
594 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
595 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
596 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
597 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
598 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
599 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
600 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
601 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
602 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
603 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
604
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100605 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606
607 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
608 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
609 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
610
611 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200612 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
613 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
614 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
615 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
616 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
617 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200618
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200619 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200620
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100621log-send-hostname [<string>]
622 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
623 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
624 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
625 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
626 the logs.
627
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000628log-tag <string>
629 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
630 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
631 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100632 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000633
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200634nbproc <number>
635 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
636 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
637 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
638 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
639 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
640
641pidfile <pidfile>
642 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
643 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
644 starting the process. See also "daemon".
645
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100646stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200647 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
648 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
649 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
650 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
651 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
652 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100653 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200654 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
655 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200656
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100657ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
658 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
659 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300660 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100661 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
662 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
663 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
664 "bind" keyword for more information.
665
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100666ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
667 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
668 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
669 keyword to see available options.
670
671 Example:
672 global
673 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
674
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100675ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
676 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
677 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300678 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100679 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
680 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
681 information.
682
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100683ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
684 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
685 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
686 keyword to see available options.
687
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100688ssl-server-verify [none|required]
689 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
690 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
691 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
692
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200693stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
694 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
695 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
696 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
697 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200698
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200699 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
700 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
701 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200702
703stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
704 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
705 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100706 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200707
708stats maxconn <connections>
709 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
710 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
711
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200712uid <number>
713 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
714 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
715 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
716 one. See also "gid" and "user".
717
718ulimit-n <number>
719 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
720 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
721 option.
722
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100723unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
724 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
725
726 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
727 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
728 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
729 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
730 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
731 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
732 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
733 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
734 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
735 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
736
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200737user <user name>
738 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
739 See also "uid" and "group".
740
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200741node <name>
742 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
743
744 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
745 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
746 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
747 traffic.
748
749description <text>
750 Add a text that describes the instance.
751
752 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
753 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
754 "<" and ">" characters.
755
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200756
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007573.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200758-----------------------
759
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200760max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
761 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
762 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
763 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
764 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
765 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
766 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
767 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
768 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
769
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200770maxconn <number>
771 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
772 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
773 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +0200774 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
775 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
776 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
777 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100778 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
779 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
780 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
781 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
782 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200783
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200784maxconnrate <number>
785 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
786 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
787 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
788 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
789 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
790 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
791 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
792 fairness.
793
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100794maxcomprate <number>
795 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300796 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100797 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
798 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
799 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
800 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
801 default value.
802
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100803maxcompcpuusage <number>
804 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
805 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
806 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
807 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
808 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
809 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
810 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
811 process down and from introducing high latencies.
812
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100813maxpipes <number>
814 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
815 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
816 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
817 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
818 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
819 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
820
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200821maxsessrate <number>
822 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
823 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
824 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
825 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
826 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
827 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
828 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
829 fairness.
830
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200831maxsslconn <number>
832 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
833 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
834 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
835 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
836 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
837 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
838 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +0100839 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
840 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
841 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
842 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
843 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
844 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
845 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200846
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200847maxsslrate <number>
848 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
849 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
850 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
851 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
852 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
853 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
854 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
855 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
856 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
857 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
858
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100859maxzlibmem <number>
860 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
861 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
862 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100863 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
864 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
865 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
866
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200867noepoll
868 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
869 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100870 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200871
872nokqueue
873 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
874 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
875 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
876
877nopoll
878 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
879 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100880 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100881 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200882
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100883nosplice
884 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
885 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
886 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100887 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100888 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
889 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
890 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
891 "option splice-response".
892
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300893nogetaddrinfo
894 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
895 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
896
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200897spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900898 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
899 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
900 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
901 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
902 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
903 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200904
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +0100905tune.buffers.limit <number>
906 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
907 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
908 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
909 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
910 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
911 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
912 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
913 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
914 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
915 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
916 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
917 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
918 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
919 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
920 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
921
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +0100922tune.buffers.reserve <number>
923 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
924 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
925 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
926 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
927
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200928tune.bufsize <number>
929 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
930 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
931 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
932 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
933 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
934 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
935 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
936 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400937 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
938 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
939 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200940
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200941tune.chksize <number>
942 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
943 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
944 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
945 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
946 checks whenever possible.
947
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100948tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
949 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
950 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
951 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
952 this value. The default value is 1.
953
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100954tune.http.cookielen <number>
955 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
956 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
957 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
958 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
959 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
960 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
961 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
962 to change this value.
963
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200964tune.http.maxhdr <number>
965 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
966 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
967 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
968 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
969 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
970 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
971 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
972 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
973 limit too high.
974
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100975tune.idletimer <timeout>
976 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
977 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
978 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
979 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
980 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
981 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
982 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
983 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
984 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
985
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100986tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100987 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
988 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
989 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
990 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
991 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
992 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
993 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
994 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
995 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
996 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100997
998tune.maxpollevents <number>
999 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1000 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1001 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1002 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1003 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1004
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001005tune.maxrewrite <number>
1006 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1007 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1008 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1009 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1010 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1011 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1012 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1013 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1014 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1015 bufsize.
1016
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001017tune.pipesize <number>
1018 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1019 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1020 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1021 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1022 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1023 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1024
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001025tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1026tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1027 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1028 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1029 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1030 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1031 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1032 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1033 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1034
1035tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1036tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1037 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1038 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1039 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1040 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1041 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1042 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1043 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1044 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1045 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1046 notifying haproxy again.
1047
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001048tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001049 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1050 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1051 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001052 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001053 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1054 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1055 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1056 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1057 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001058 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1059 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001060
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001061tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1062 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1063 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1064 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1065 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1066 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1067 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1068
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001069tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1070 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001071 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001072 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1073 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1074 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1075 being used for too long.
1076
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001077tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1078 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1079 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1080 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1081 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1082 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1083 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1084 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1085 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1086 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1087 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001088 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1089 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001090
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001091tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1092 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1093 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1094 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1095 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1096 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1097 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1098 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
1099 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied via the certificate file.
1100
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001101tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1102 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001103 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001104 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1105 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1106 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1107
1108tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1109 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1110 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1111 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1112 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001113
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011143.3. Debugging
1115--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001116
1117debug
1118 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1119 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1120 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1121 system startup.
1122
1123quiet
1124 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1125 line argument "-q".
1126
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001127
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011283.4. Userlists
1129--------------
1130It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1131http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1132it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1133
1134userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001135 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001136 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1137
1138group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001139 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001140 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1141 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1142
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001143user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1144 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001145 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1146 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001147 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1148 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001149 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001150 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001151
1152
1153 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001154 userlist L1
1155 group G1 users tiger,scott
1156 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001157
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001158 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1159 user scott insecure-password elgato
1160 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001161
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001162 userlist L2
1163 group G1
1164 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001165
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001166 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1167 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1168 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001169
1170 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001171
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001172
11733.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001174----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001175It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1176haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1177pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1178identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1179or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1180Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1181known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1182the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1183process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1184during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1185tables.
1186
1187peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001188 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001189 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1190
1191peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1192 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1193 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1194 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1195 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1196 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1197 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1198
1199 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1200 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1201
1202 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1203 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1204 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1205 across all peers.
1206
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001207 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1208 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1209 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1210
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001211 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001212 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001213 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1214 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1215 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001216
1217 backend mybackend
1218 mode tcp
1219 balance roundrobin
1220 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1221 stick on src
1222
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001223 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1224 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001225
1226
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012274. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001228----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001229
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001230Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1231 - defaults <name>
1232 - frontend <name>
1233 - backend <name>
1234 - listen <name>
1235
1236A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1237its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1238section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001239section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001240
1241A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1242connections.
1243
1244A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1245to forward incoming connections.
1246
1247A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1248parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1249
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001250All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1251'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1252case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1253
1254Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1255logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1256proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1257However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1258name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1259
1260Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1261and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001262bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001263protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1264modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1265arbitrary criteria.
1266
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001267In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1268a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1269the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1270
1271 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1272 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1273 between responses and new requests.
1274
1275 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1276 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1277 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1278 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1279
1280 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1281 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1282 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1283
1284 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1285 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1286 client-facing connection remains open.
1287
1288 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1289 after the end of the response.
1290
1291The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1292frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1293following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1294weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1295
1296 Backend mode
1297
1298 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1299 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1300 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1301 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1302 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1303 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1304 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1305 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1306 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1307 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1308 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1309
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001310
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001311
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013124.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1313--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001314
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001315The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1316limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1317they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1318limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001319marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001320option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001321and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1322with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1323specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001324
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001325
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001326 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1327------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1328acl - X X X
1329appsession - - X X
1330backlog X X X -
1331balance X - X X
1332bind - X X -
1333bind-process X X X X
1334block - X X X
1335capture cookie - X X -
1336capture request header - X X -
1337capture response header - X X -
1338clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001339compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001340contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1341cookie X - X X
1342default-server X - X X
1343default_backend X X X -
1344description - X X X
1345disabled X X X X
1346dispatch - - X X
1347enabled X X X X
1348errorfile X X X X
1349errorloc X X X X
1350errorloc302 X X X X
1351-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1352errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001353force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001354fullconn X - X X
1355grace X X X X
1356hash-type X - X X
1357http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001358http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001359http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001360http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001361http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001362http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001363id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001364ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001365log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001366log-format X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001367log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001368max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001369maxconn X X X -
1370mode X X X X
1371monitor fail - X X -
1372monitor-net X X X -
1373monitor-uri X X X -
1374option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1375option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1376option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1377option allbackups (*) X - X X
1378option checkcache (*) X - X X
1379option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1380option contstats (*) X X X -
1381option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1382option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1383option forceclose (*) X X X X
1384-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1385option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001386option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001387option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001388option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001389option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001390option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001391option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1392option httpchk X - X X
1393option httpclose (*) X X X X
1394option httplog X X X X
1395option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001396option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001397option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001398option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001399option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1400option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1401option logasap (*) X X X -
1402option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001403option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001404option nolinger (*) X X X X
1405option originalto X X X X
1406option persist (*) X - X X
1407option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001408option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001409option smtpchk X - X X
1410option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1411option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1412option splice-request (*) X X X X
1413option splice-response (*) X X X X
1414option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1415option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1416-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001417option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001418option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1419option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1420option tcpka X X X X
1421option tcplog X X X X
1422option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001423external-check command X - X X
1424external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001425persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1426rate-limit sessions X X X -
1427redirect - X X X
1428redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1429redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1430reqadd - X X X
1431reqallow - X X X
1432reqdel - X X X
1433reqdeny - X X X
1434reqiallow - X X X
1435reqidel - X X X
1436reqideny - X X X
1437reqipass - X X X
1438reqirep - X X X
1439reqisetbe - X X X
1440reqitarpit - X X X
1441reqpass - X X X
1442reqrep - X X X
1443-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1444reqsetbe - X X X
1445reqtarpit - X X X
1446retries X - X X
1447rspadd - X X X
1448rspdel - X X X
1449rspdeny - X X X
1450rspidel - X X X
1451rspideny - X X X
1452rspirep - X X X
1453rsprep - X X X
1454server - - X X
1455source X - X X
1456srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001457stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001458stats auth X - X X
1459stats enable X - X X
1460stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001461stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001462stats realm X - X X
1463stats refresh X - X X
1464stats scope X - X X
1465stats show-desc X - X X
1466stats show-legends X - X X
1467stats show-node X - X X
1468stats uri X - X X
1469-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1470stick match - - X X
1471stick on - - X X
1472stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001473stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001474stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001475tcp-check connect - - X X
1476tcp-check expect - - X X
1477tcp-check send - - X X
1478tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001479tcp-request connection - X X -
1480tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001481tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001482tcp-response content - - X X
1483tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001484timeout check X - X X
1485timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001486timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001487timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1488timeout connect X - X X
1489timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1490timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1491timeout http-request X X X X
1492timeout queue X - X X
1493timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001494timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001495timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1496timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001497timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001498transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001499unique-id-format X X X -
1500unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001501use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001502use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001503------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1504 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001505
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001506
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015074.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1508---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001509
1510This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1511
1512
1513acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1514 Declare or complete an access list.
1515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1516 no | yes | yes | yes
1517 Example:
1518 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1519 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1520 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1521
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001522 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001523
1524
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001525appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1526 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001527 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1529 no | no | yes | yes
1530 Arguments :
1531 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1532 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1533
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001534 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001535 checked in each cookie value.
1536
1537 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1538 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1539 milliseconds.
1540
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001541 request-learn
1542 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1543 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1544 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1545 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1546 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1547 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1548
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001549 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1550 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1551 data following this prefix.
1552
1553 Example :
1554 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1555
1556 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1557 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1558
1559 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1560 2 modes are currently supported :
1561 - path-parameters :
1562 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1563 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1564 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1565 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1566 - query-string :
1567 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1568 query string.
1569
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001570 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1571 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1572 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1573 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001574 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1575 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1576 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001577 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1578 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1579
1580 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1581
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001582 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1583 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1584 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1585
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001586 Example :
1587 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1588
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001589 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1590 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001591
1592
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001593backlog <conns>
1594 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1596 yes | yes | yes | no
1597 Arguments :
1598 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1599 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001600 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001601
1602 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1603 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1604 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1605 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1606 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1607 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1608 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1609 backlog parameter.
1610
1611 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1612 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1613 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1614
1615 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1616
1617
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001618balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001619balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001620 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1622 yes | no | yes | yes
1623 Arguments :
1624 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1625 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1626 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1627 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1628
1629 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1630 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1631 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1632 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001633 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001634 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001635 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1636 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1637 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1638 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1639 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1640 it, so that you don't worry.
1641
1642 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1643 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1644 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1645 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1646 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1647 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1648 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1649 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001650
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001651 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1652 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1653 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1654 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1655 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1656 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1657 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1658 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1659
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001660 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001661 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001662 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1663 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001664 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001665 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1666 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1667 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1668 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1669 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001670 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1671 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1672 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1673 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1674 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1675 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001676
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001677 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1678 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1679 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1680 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1681 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1682 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1683 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1684 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001685 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001686 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001687 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1688 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1689 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001690
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001691 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1692 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1693 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1694 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1695 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1696 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1697 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1698 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1699 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1700 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1701 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1702 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001703
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001704 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001705 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1706 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1707 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1708 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1709 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1710 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1711 URIs start with a leading "/".
1712
1713 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1714 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1715 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1716 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1717
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001718 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001719 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1720
1721 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001722 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1723 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001724 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1725 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1726 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1727 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001728 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001729 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1730 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001731
1732 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1733 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1734 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1735 server will receive the request.
1736
1737 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1738 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1739 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1740 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1741 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001742 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1743 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1744 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001745
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001746 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1747 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1748 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1749 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1750 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001751
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001752 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001753 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1754 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1755 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1756
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001757 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1758 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1759 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1760
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001761 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001762 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001763 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1764 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1765 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1766 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1767 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1768 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001769 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001770 used instead.
1771
1772 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1773 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1774 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1775 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1776
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001777 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1778 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1779 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1780
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001781 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001782
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001783 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001784 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1785 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001786
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001787 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1788 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1789 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001790
1791 Examples :
1792 balance roundrobin
1793 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001794 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001795 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1796 balance hdr(host)
1797 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001798
1799 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1800 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1801
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001802 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001803 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1804 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1805 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1806 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1807
1808 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1809 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1810 defaults to 16 kB.
1811
1812 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1813 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1814
1815 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1816 Round Robin.
1817
1818 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1819 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1820 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1821 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1822
1823 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1824
1825 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001826 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001827 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1828 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1829 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001830
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001831 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1832 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001833
1834
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001835bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1836bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001837 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1839 no | yes | yes | no
1840 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001841 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1842 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1843 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1844 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001845 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001846 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1847 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1848 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1849 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1850 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1851 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1852 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02001853 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
1854 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
1855 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
1856 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
1857 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
1858 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
1859 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001860 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1861 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1862 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001863 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1864 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1865 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1866 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001867
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001868 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1869 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001870 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1871 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1872 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001873 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1874 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1875 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1876 the range.
1877
1878 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1879 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1880 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1881 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1882 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1883 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1884 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001885 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001886 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001887
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001888 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1889 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1890 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1891 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1892 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1893 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1894 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1895 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1896
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001897 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1898 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1899 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1900 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001901
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001902 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1903 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1904 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1905 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1906 in a frontend.
1907
1908 Example :
1909 listen http_proxy
1910 bind :80,:443
1911 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001912 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001913
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001914 listen http_https_proxy
1915 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001916 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001917
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001918 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1919 bind ipv6@:80
1920 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1921 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1922
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001923 listen external_bind_app1
1924 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1925
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001926 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001927 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001928
1929
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001930bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001931 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1933 yes | yes | yes | yes
1934 Arguments :
1935 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1936 may be used to override a default value.
1937
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001938 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001939 option may be combined with other numbers.
1940
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001941 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001942 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1943 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1944 missing from all processes.
1945
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001946 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001947 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02001948 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
1949 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
1950 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
1951 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001952
1953 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1954 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1955 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1956 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1957 and 'even' instances.
1958
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001959 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
1960 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
1961 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
1962 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001963
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001964 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
1965 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
1966
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02001967 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
1968 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
1969 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
1970
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001971 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1972 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1973
1974 Example :
1975 listen app_ip1
1976 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001977 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001978
1979 listen app_ip2
1980 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001981 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001982
1983 listen management
1984 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001985 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001986
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001987 listen management
1988 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1989 bind-process 1-4
1990
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001991 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001992
1993
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001994block { if | unless } <condition>
1995 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1996 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1997 no | yes | yes | yes
1998
1999 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2000 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002001 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002002 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002003 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2004 "block" statements per instance.
2005
2006 Example:
2007 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2008 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2009 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2010 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2011
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002012 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002013
2014
2015capture cookie <name> len <length>
2016 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2018 no | yes | yes | no
2019 Arguments :
2020 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2021 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2022 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2023 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2024 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2025
2026 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2027 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2028 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2029 right if it exceeds <length>.
2030
2031 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2032 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2033 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2034 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2035
2036 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2037 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2038 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2039
2040 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2041 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2042 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002043 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2044 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2045 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002046
2047 Example:
2048 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2049
2050 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002051 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002052
2053
2054capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002055 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2057 no | yes | yes | no
2058 Arguments :
2059 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002060 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002061 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2062 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2063 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2064
2065 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2066 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2067 it exceeds <length>.
2068
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002069 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002070 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2071 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002072 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2073 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2074 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2075 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002076 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002077 environments to find where the request came from.
2078
2079 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2080 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2081 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2082 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002083
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002084 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2085 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2086 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2087 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2088 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002089
2090 Example:
2091 capture request header Host len 15
2092 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
2093 capture request header Referrer len 15
2094
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002095 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002096 about logging.
2097
2098
2099capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002100 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2102 no | yes | yes | no
2103 Arguments :
2104 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002105 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002106 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2107 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2108 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2109
2110 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2111 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2112 it exceeds <length>.
2113
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002114 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002115 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2116 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2117 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002118 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2119 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2120 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2121 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002122
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002123 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2124 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2125 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2126 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2127 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002128
2129 Example:
2130 capture response header Content-length len 9
2131 capture response header Location len 15
2132
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002133 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002134 about logging.
2135
2136
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002137clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002138 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2140 yes | yes | yes | no
2141 Arguments :
2142 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2143 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2144 as explained at the top of this document.
2145
2146 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2147 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2148 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2149 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2150 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2151 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2152 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2153 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002154 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002155 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2156 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2157
2158 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2159 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2160 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2161 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2162 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2163 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2164
2165 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2166 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2167
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002168 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2169 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002170
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002171compression algo <algorithm> ...
2172compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002173compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002174 Enable HTTP compression.
2175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2176 yes | yes | yes | yes
2177 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002178 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2179 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2180 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2181
2182 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002183 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002184 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2185 data.
2186
2187 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2188 support for zlib was built in.
2189
2190 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2191 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2192 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2193 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2194 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2195 in.
2196
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002197 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002198 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002199 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2200 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2201 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2202 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2203 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002204
2205 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2206 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2207 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2208 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2209 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002210 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2211 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2212 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2213 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2214 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002215 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2216 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002217
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002218 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002219 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2220 "Accept-Encoding" header
2221 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002222 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002223 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2224 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002225 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2226 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2227 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2228 "multipart"
2229 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2230 header
2231 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2232 and later
2233 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2234 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002235
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002236 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2237 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002238
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002239 Examples :
2240 compression algo gzip
2241 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002242
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002243contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002244 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2245 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2246 yes | no | yes | yes
2247 Arguments :
2248 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2249 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2250 as explained at the top of this document.
2251
2252 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002253 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002254 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002255 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2256 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2257 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2258 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2259
2260 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2261 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2262 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2263 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2264 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2265 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2266
2267 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2268 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2269 instead.
2270
2271 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2272 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2273
2274
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002275cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002276 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2277 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002278 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2280 yes | no | yes | yes
2281 Arguments :
2282 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2283 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2284 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2285 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2286 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2287 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2288 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2289 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2290 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2291
2292 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2293 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2294 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2295 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2296 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2297 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2298 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2299 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2300 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2301 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2302 "insert" and "prefix".
2303
2304 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002305 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002306
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002307 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002308 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2309 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2310 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2311 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2312 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2313 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2314 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2315 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2316 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2317 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002318
2319 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2320 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2321 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2322 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2323 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2324 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2325 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2326 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2327 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2328 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002329 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2330 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2331 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002332
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002333 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2334 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2335 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002336 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2337 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2338 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2339 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002340 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2341 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2342 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002343
2344 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2345 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2346 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2347 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2348 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2349 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2350 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2351 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2352 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2353
2354 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2355 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2356 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2357 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2358 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2359 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2360 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2361 persistence cookie in the cache.
2362 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2363
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002364 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2365 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2366 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2367 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2368 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2369 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2370 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2371 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2372 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2373 they logout.
2374
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002375 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2376 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2377 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2378 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2379
2380 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2381 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2382 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2383 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2384 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2385 this attribute.
2386
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002387 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002388 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002389 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2390 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2391 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2392 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2393 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2394 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002395
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002396 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2397 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2398 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2399 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2400 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2401 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2402 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2403 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2404 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2405 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2406 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2407 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2408 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2409 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2410 the site.
2411
2412 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2413 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2414 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2415 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2416 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2417 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2418 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2419 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2420 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2421 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2422 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2423 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2424 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2425 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2426 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2427 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2428
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002429 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2430 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2431 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2432 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002433
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002434 Examples :
2435 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2436 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2437 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002438 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002439
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002440 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002441 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002442
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002443
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002444default-server [param*]
2445 Change default options for a server in a backend
2446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2447 yes | no | yes | yes
2448 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002449 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2450 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2451 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2452 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002453
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002454 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002455 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2456
2457 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002458
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002459
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002460default_backend <backend>
2461 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2463 yes | yes | yes | no
2464 Arguments :
2465 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2466
2467 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2468 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2469 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2470 will catch all undetermined requests.
2471
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002472 Example :
2473
2474 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2475 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2476 default_backend dynamic
2477
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002478 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2479
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002480
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002481description <string>
2482 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2484 no | yes | yes | yes
2485 Arguments : string
2486
2487 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2488 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2489 it describes.
2490 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2491
2492
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002493disabled
2494 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2496 yes | yes | yes | yes
2497 Arguments : none
2498
2499 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2500 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2501 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2502 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2503 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2504 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2505 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2506
2507 See also : "enabled"
2508
2509
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002510dispatch <address>:<port>
2511 Set a default server address
2512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2513 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002514 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002515
2516 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2517 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2518 during start-up.
2519
2520 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2521 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2522 possible with normal servers.
2523
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002524 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002525 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2526 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2527 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2528 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2529
2530 See also : "server"
2531
2532
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002533enabled
2534 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2536 yes | yes | yes | yes
2537 Arguments : none
2538
2539 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2540 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2541
2542 See also : "disabled"
2543
2544
2545errorfile <code> <file>
2546 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2548 yes | yes | yes | yes
2549 Arguments :
2550 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002551 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002552
2553 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002554 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002555 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002556 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2557 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002558
2559 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2560 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2561 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2562
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002563 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2564
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002565 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2566 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2567 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2568 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2569
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002570 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2571 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2572 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2573 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2574 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2575 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2576
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002577 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2578 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2579 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002580 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002581 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2582
2583 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2584
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002585 Example :
2586 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002587 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002588 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2589 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2590
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002591
2592errorloc <code> <url>
2593errorloc302 <code> <url>
2594 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2596 yes | yes | yes | yes
2597 Arguments :
2598 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002599 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002600
2601 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2602 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2603 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2604 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2605 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2606
2607 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2608 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2609 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2610
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002611 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2612
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002613 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2614 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2615 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2616 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2617 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2618 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2619 request.
2620
2621 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2622
2623
2624errorloc303 <code> <url>
2625 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2627 yes | yes | yes | yes
2628 Arguments :
2629 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2630 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2631
2632 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2633 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2634 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2635 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2636 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2637
2638 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2639 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2640 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2641
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002642 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2643
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002644 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2645 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2646 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2647 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002648 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002649
2650 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2651
2652
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002653force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2654 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2655 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2656 no | yes | yes | yes
2657
2658 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2659 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2660 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2661 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2662 marked down for maintenance operations.
2663
2664 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2665 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2666 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2667 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2668 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2669 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2670 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2671 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2672 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2673
2674 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2675 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2676 is used.
2677
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002678 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002679 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002680
2681
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002682fullconn <conns>
2683 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2685 yes | no | yes | yes
2686 Arguments :
2687 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2688 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2689
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002690 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002691 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002692 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002693 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2694 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2695 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2696 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2697 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002698 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002699
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002700 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2701 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002702 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2703 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2704 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002705
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002706 Example :
2707 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2708 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2709 # connections.
2710 backend dynamic
2711 fullconn 10000
2712 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2713 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2714
2715 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2716
2717
2718grace <time>
2719 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002721 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002722 Arguments :
2723 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2724 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2725 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2726
2727 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2728 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002729 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002730 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2731
2732 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2733 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2734 simplify it.
2735
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002736
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002737hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002738 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2740 yes | no | yes | yes
2741 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002742 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2743 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002744
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002745 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2746 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2747 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2748 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2749 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2750 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2751 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2752 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2753 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2754 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002755
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002756 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2757 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2758 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2759 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2760 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2761 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2762 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2763 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2764 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2765 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2766 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2767 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2768 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002769 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2770 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002771
2772 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2773
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002774 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002775 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2776 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2777 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002778 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2779 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2780 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002781
2782 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2783 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002784 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2785 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2786 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2787 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2788
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002789 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2790 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2791 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2792 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2793 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2794 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2795 parameter.
2796
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002797 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2798
2799 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2800 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2801 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2802 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2803 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2804 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2805 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2806 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2807 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2808 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2809 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2810 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002811
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002812 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2813 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2814 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002815
2816 See also : "balance", "server"
2817
2818
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002819http-check disable-on-404
2820 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002822 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002823 Arguments : none
2824
2825 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2826 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2827 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2828 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2829 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2830 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2831 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2832 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002833 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2834 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2835 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2836
2837 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2838
2839
2840http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002841 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002843 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002844 Arguments :
2845 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2846 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002847 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002848 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2849 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2850 details on the supported keywords.
2851
2852 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2853 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2854 with the usual backslash ('\').
2855
2856 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2857 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2858 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2859 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2860 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2861
2862 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002863 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002864 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2865 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2866 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2867
2868 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002869 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002870 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2871 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2872 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2873 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2874
2875 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002876 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002877 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2878 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2879 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2880 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2881 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2882 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2883 trace).
2884
2885 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002886 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002887 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2888 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2889 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2890 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2891 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2892 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2893
2894 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2895 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2896 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2897 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2898 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2899 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2900 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2901 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2902
2903 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2904 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2905
2906 Examples :
2907 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002908 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002909
2910 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002911 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002912
2913 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002914 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002915
2916 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002917 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002918
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002919 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002920
2921
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002922http-check send-state
2923 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2924 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2925 yes | no | yes | yes
2926 Arguments : none
2927
2928 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2929 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2930 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2931 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2932 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2933
2934 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2935 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2936 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2937 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2938 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2939 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2940 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2941 checked in multiple backends.
2942
2943 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2944 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2945
2946 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2947 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2948 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2949 one fails.
2950
2951 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2952 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2953 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2954
2955 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2956 server's queue.
2957
2958 Example of a header received by the application server :
2959 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2960 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2961
2962 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2963
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002964http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002965 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002966 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06002967 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
2968 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002969 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
2970 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2971 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2972 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02002973 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
2974 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002975 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002976 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002977 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2978
2979 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2980 no | yes | yes | yes
2981
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002982 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2983 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2984 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2985 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2986 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002987
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002988 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2989 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2990 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2991
2992 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2993 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2994 are evaluated.
2995
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002996 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2997 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2998 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2999 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3000 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3001 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3002 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3003 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3004 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003005 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003006 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
3007
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003008 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3009 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3010 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3011 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3012 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3013
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003014 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3015 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3016 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003017 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3018 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003019
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003020 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3021 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3022 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3023 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3024 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3025 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3026 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3027 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3028
3029 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3030 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3031 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3032 external users.
3033
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003034 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3035 <name>.
3036
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003037 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3038 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3039 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3040 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3041 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3042 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3043 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3044 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3045
3046 Example:
3047
3048 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3049
3050 applied to:
3051
3052 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3053
3054 outputs:
3055
3056 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3057
3058 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3059
3060 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3061 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3062 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3063 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3064 header.
3065
3066 Example:
3067
3068 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3069
3070 applied to:
3071
3072 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3073
3074 outputs:
3075
3076 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3077
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003078 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3079 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3080 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3081 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3082 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3083 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3084 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3085 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3086
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003087 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3088 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3089 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3090 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3091 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3092 another equipment.
3093
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003094 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3095 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3096 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3097 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3098 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3099 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3100 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3101 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3102
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003103 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3104 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3105 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3106 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3107 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3108 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3109 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3110 admin privileges.
3111
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003112 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3113 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3114 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3115 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3116 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3117 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3118 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3119 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3120
3121 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3122 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3123 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3124 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3125 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3126 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3127
3128 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3129 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3130 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3131 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3132 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3133 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3134
3135 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3136 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3137 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3138 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3139 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3140 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3141 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3142 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3143 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3144
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003145 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3146 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3147 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3148 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3149 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3150 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3151 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3152 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3153 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3154 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3155 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3156 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3157
3158 These actions take one or two arguments :
3159 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3160 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3161 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3162 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3163
3164 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3165 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3166 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3167 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3168
3169 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3170 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3171 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3172 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3173 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3174 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3175 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3176 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3177
3178 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3179 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3180 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3181 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3182 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3183
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003184 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3185
3186 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3187 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3188 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3189 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003190
3191 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003192 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3193 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3194 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003195
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003196 http-request allow if nagios
3197 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3198 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3199 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003200
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003201 Example:
3202 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003203 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003204
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003205 Example:
3206 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3207 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3208 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3209 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3210 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3211 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3212 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3213 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3214 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3215
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003216 Example:
3217 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3218 acl add path /addacl
3219 acl del path /delacl
3220
3221 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3222
3223 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3224 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3225
3226 Example:
3227 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3228 acl setmap path /setmap
3229 acl delmap path /delmap
3230
3231 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3232
3233 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3234 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3235
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003236 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3237 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003238
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003239http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003240 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003241 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3242 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003243 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3244 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3245 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3246 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3247 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3248 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003249 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003250 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3251
3252 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3253 no | yes | yes | yes
3254
3255 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3256 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3257 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3258 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3259 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3260 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3261
3262 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3263 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3264 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3265 current section.
3266
3267 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3268 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3269 rules are evaluated.
3270
3271 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3272 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3273 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3274 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3275 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3276 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3277 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3278
3279 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3280 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3281 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3282 external users.
3283
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003284 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3285 <name>.
3286
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003287 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3288 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3289 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3290 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3291 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3292 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3293 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3294 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
3295
3296 Example:
3297
3298 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
3299
3300 applied to:
3301
3302 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3303
3304 outputs:
3305
3306 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
3307
3308 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
3309
3310 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3311 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3312 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3313 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3314 header.
3315
3316 Example:
3317
3318 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
3319
3320 applied to:
3321
3322 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
3323
3324 outputs:
3325
3326 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
3327
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003328 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3329 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3330 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3331 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3332 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3333 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3334 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3335 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3336
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003337 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3338 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3339 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3340 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3341 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3342 another equipment.
3343
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003344 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3345 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3346 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3347 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3348 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3349 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3350 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3351 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3352
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003353 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3354 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3355 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3356 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3357 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3358 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3359 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3360 admin privileges.
3361
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003362 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3363 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3364 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3365 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3366 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3367 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3368 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3369 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3370
3371 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3372 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3373 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3374 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3375 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3376 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3377
3378 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3379 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3380 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3381 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3382 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3383 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3384
3385 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3386 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3387 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3388 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3389 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3390 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3391 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3392 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3393 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3394
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003395 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3396
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003397 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003398 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3399 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3400 rules.
3401
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003402 Example:
3403 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3404
3405 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3406
3407 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3408 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3409
3410 Example:
3411 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3412
3413 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3414
3415 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3416 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3417
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003418 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3419 ACL usage.
3420
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003421
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003422http-send-name-header [<header>]
3423 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3424
3425 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3426 yes | no | yes | yes
3427
3428 Arguments :
3429
3430 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3431
3432 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3433 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3434 is added with the header string proved.
3435
3436 See also : "server"
3437
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003438id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003439 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3441 no | yes | yes | yes
3442 Arguments : none
3443
3444 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3445 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3446 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003447
3448
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003449ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3450 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3451 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3452 no | yes | yes | yes
3453
3454 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3455 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3456 and running).
3457
3458 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3459 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3460 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003461 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003462 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3463
3464 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3465 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3466
3467 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3468 "unless" condition is met.
3469
3470 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3471
3472
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003473log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003474log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003475no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003476 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3478 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003479
3480 Prefix :
3481 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3482 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3483 prefix does not allow arguments.
3484
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003485 Arguments :
3486 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3487 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3488 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3489 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3490 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3491 parameter.
3492
3493 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3494 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3495
3496 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3497 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3498 standard syslog port).
3499
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003500 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3501 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3502 standard syslog port).
3503
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003504 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3505 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3506 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3507 appropriately writeable).
3508
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003509 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3510 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3511 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3512 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3513
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02003514 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
3515 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
3516 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
3517 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
3518 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
3519 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
3520 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
3521 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
3522 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
3523 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
3524 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
3525
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003526 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3527
3528 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3529 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3530 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3531
3532 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3533 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3534 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003535 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3536 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3537 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3538 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3539 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003540
3541 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3542
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003543 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3544 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3545 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003546
3547 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3548 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3549 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3550 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3551
3552 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3553 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003554
3555 Example :
3556 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003557 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3558 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003559 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3560
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003561
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003562log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003563 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
3564 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3565 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003566
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003567 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
3568 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
3569 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
3570 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
3571 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003572
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003573log-tag <string>
3574 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
3575 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3576 yes | yes | yes | yes
3577
3578 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
3579 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
3580 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
3581 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
3582 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
3583 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
3584 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
3585 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
3586 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003587
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003588max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3589 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3590 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3591 yes | no | yes | yes
3592
3593 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3594 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3595 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3596 servers.
3597
3598 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3599 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3600 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3601 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3602 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3603 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3604 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3605 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3606 picking a different server.
3607
3608 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3609 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3610 even if they have to be queued.
3611
3612 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3613 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3614
3615
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003616maxconn <conns>
3617 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3619 yes | yes | yes | no
3620 Arguments :
3621 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3622 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3623 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3624 closes.
3625
3626 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3627 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3628 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3629 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3630 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3631 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3632 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3633 properly tuned.
3634
3635 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3636 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3637 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3638
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003639 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3640
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003641 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3642
3643
3644mode { tcp|http|health }
3645 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3647 yes | yes | yes | yes
3648 Arguments :
3649 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3650 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3651 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3652 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3653
3654 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3655 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3656 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3657 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3658 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3659
3660 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003661 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3662 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3663 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3664 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3665 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3666 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3667 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003668
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003669 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3670 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3671 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003672
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003673 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003674 defaults http_instances
3675 mode http
3676
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003677 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003678
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003679
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003680monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003681 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3683 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003684 Arguments :
3685 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3686 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003687 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003688 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3689 backend and its backup.
3690
3691 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3692 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3693 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3694 servers in a list of backends.
3695
3696 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3697 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3698 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3699 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3700 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3701 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3702 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003703 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3704 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003705
3706 Example:
3707 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003708 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003709 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3710 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3711 monitor-uri /site_alive
3712 monitor fail if site_dead
3713
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003714 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003715
3716
3717monitor-net <source>
3718 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3720 yes | yes | yes | no
3721 Arguments :
3722 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3723 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3724 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3725 followed by a mask.
3726
3727 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3728 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003729 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003730 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3731
3732 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3733 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3734 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3735 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003736 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3737 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3738 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003739
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003740 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3741 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3742 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3743 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3744 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3745 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003746
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003747 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3748 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003749
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003750 Example :
3751 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3752 frontend www
3753 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3754
3755 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3756
3757
3758monitor-uri <uri>
3759 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3761 yes | yes | yes | no
3762 Arguments :
3763 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3764 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3765
3766 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3767 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3768 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3769 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3770 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3771 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3772 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3773 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3774
3775 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3776 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3777 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3778 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3779 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3780 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3781
3782 Example :
3783 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3784 frontend www
3785 mode http
3786 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3787
3788 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3789
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003790
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003791option abortonclose
3792no option abortonclose
3793 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3795 yes | no | yes | yes
3796 Arguments : none
3797
3798 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3799 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3800 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3801 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003802 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003803 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3804 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3805 encountered while delivering the response.
3806
3807 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3808 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3809 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3810 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3811 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3812 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003813 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003814 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003815 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003816 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3817 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3818 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3819
3820 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3821 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3822 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3823 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3824 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3825 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3826 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3827 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003828 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003829
3830 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3831 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3832
3833 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3834
3835
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003836option accept-invalid-http-request
3837no option accept-invalid-http-request
3838 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3840 yes | yes | yes | no
3841 Arguments : none
3842
3843 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3844 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3845 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3846 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3847 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3848 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3849 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3850 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003851 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3852 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3853 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3854 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3855 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3856 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003857
3858 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3859 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3860 been confirmed.
3861
3862 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3863 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003864 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3865 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003866 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3867
3868 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3869 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3870
3871 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3872 stats socket.
3873
3874
3875option accept-invalid-http-response
3876no option accept-invalid-http-response
3877 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3879 yes | no | yes | yes
3880 Arguments : none
3881
3882 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3883 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3884 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3885 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3886 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3887 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3888 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3889 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3890 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3891
3892 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3893 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3894 been confirmed.
3895
3896 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3897 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3898 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3899 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3900
3901 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3902 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3903
3904 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3905 stats socket.
3906
3907
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003908option allbackups
3909no option allbackups
3910 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3912 yes | no | yes | yes
3913 Arguments : none
3914
3915 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3916 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3917 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3918 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3919 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3920 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3921 order between the backup servers anymore.
3922
3923 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3924 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3925
3926 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3927 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3928
3929
3930option checkcache
3931no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003932 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3934 yes | no | yes | yes
3935 Arguments : none
3936
3937 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3938 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003939 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003940 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3941 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003942 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003943
3944 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003945 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003946 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003947 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3948 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003949 to the client are :
3950 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003951 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003952 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003953 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3954 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3955 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3956 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3957 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3958 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3959 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3960 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3961 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3962 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3963 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3964
3965 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003966 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003967 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003968 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003969 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3970
3971 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3972 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003973 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003974 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3975
3976 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3977 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3978
3979
3980option clitcpka
3981no option clitcpka
3982 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3984 yes | yes | yes | no
3985 Arguments : none
3986
3987 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3988 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3989 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3990 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3991
3992 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3993 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3994 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3995 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3996
3997 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3998 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3999 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4000 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4001 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4002
4003 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4004
4005 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4006 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4007 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
4008
4009 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4010 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4011
4012 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
4013
4014
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004015option contstats
4016 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
4017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4018 yes | yes | yes | no
4019 Arguments : none
4020
4021 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
4022 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
4023 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
4024 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
4025 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
4026 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
4027 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
4028
4029
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004030option dontlog-normal
4031no option dontlog-normal
4032 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
4033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4034 yes | yes | yes | no
4035 Arguments : none
4036
4037 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
4038 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
4039 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
4040 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
4041 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
4042 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
4043 logged.
4044
4045 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
4046 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
4047 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
4048
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004049 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004050 logging.
4051
4052
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004053option dontlognull
4054no option dontlognull
4055 Enable or disable logging of null connections
4056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4057 yes | yes | yes | no
4058 Arguments : none
4059
4060 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
4061 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
4062 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
4063 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
4064 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
4065 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
4066 which typically corresponds to those probes.
4067
4068 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
4069 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
4070 would not be logged.
4071
4072 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4073 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4074
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004075 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004076
4077
4078option forceclose
4079no option forceclose
4080 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
4081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01004082 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004083 Arguments : none
4084
4085 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
4086 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
4087 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
4088 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
4089 global session times in the logs.
4090
4091 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01004092 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004093 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004094
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004095 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
4096 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
4097 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
4098
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004099 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4100 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004101
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004102 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4103 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4104
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004105 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004106
4107
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004108option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004109 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
4110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4111 yes | yes | yes | yes
4112 Arguments :
4113 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4114 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004115 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004116 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004117
4118 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
4119 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
4120 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
4121 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
4122 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
4123 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
4124 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004125 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
4126 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4127 possible that the client has already brought one.
4128
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004129 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004130 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004131 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
4132 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004133 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
4134 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004135
4136 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4137 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4138 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4139 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4140 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4141 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4142 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4143
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004144 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
4145 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
4146 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
4147 are under the control of the end-user.
4148
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004149 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004150 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4151 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004152 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
4153 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
4154 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004155
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004156 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004157 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
4158 frontend www
4159 mode http
4160 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
4161
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02004162 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
4163 backend www
4164 mode http
4165 option forwardfor header X-Client
4166
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004167 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004168 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004169
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004170
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004171option http-keep-alive
4172no option http-keep-alive
4173 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
4174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4175 yes | yes | yes | yes
4176 Arguments : none
4177
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004178 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4179 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4180 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
4181 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
4182 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4183 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
4184 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
4185
4186 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
4187 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004188 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
4189 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
4190 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
4191 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
4192 situations where this option may be useful :
4193
4194 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
4195 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
4196
4197 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
4198 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
4199
4200 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
4201 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
4202 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
4203 request.
4204
4205 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
4206 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004207 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
4208 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
4209 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004210
4211 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
4212 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
4213
4214 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4215 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4216 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4217 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
4218 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4219 not set.
4220
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004221 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
4222 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004223 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004224 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004225
4226 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004227 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
4228 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004229
4230
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004231option http-no-delay
4232no option http-no-delay
4233 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
4234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4235 yes | yes | yes | yes
4236 Arguments : none
4237
4238 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
4239 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
4240 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
4241 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
4242 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
4243 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
4244 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
4245 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
4246 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
4247 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
4248 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
4249 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
4250 affected.
4251
4252 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
4253 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
4254 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4255 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4256 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4257 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4258 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4259 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4260 latency environments.
4261
4262
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004263option http-pretend-keepalive
4264no option http-pretend-keepalive
4265 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4267 yes | yes | yes | yes
4268 Arguments : none
4269
4270 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4271 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4272 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4273 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4274 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4275 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4276 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4277 consider the response complete.
4278
4279 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4280 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4281 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4282 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4283 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4284 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4285
4286 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4287 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4288 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4289 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4290 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4291 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4292 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4293
4294 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4295 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004296 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004297 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4298 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004299
4300 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4301 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4302
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004303 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4304 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004305
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004306
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004307option http-server-close
4308no option http-server-close
4309 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4311 yes | yes | yes | yes
4312 Arguments : none
4313
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004314 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4315 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4316 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4317 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4318 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4319 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4320 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4321 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4322 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4323 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4324 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4325 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4326 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4327 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4328 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4329 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004330
4331 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4332 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4333 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4334 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004335 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4336 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004337
4338 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4339 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004340 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4341 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004342 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4343 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004344
4345 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4346 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4347
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004348 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004349 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4350 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004351
4352
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004353option http-tunnel
4354no option http-tunnel
4355 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4357 yes | yes | yes | yes
4358 Arguments : none
4359
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004360 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4361 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4362 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4363 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4364 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4365 "option http-tunnel".
4366
4367 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004368 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004369 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4370 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4371 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4372 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4373 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4374 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4375 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004376
4377 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4378 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4379
4380 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4381 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4382 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4383
4384
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004385option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004386no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004387 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4389 yes | yes | yes | no
4390 Arguments : none
4391
4392 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4393 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4394 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4395 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4396 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4397 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4398 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4399
4400 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4401 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4402 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4403 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4404 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4405 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4406 request along its whole life.
4407
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004408 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4409 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4410 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4411 front of an existing proxy.
4412
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004413 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4414
4415 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4416 http-server-close".
4417
4418
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004419option httpchk
4420option httpchk <uri>
4421option httpchk <method> <uri>
4422option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4423 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4425 yes | no | yes | yes
4426 Arguments :
4427 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4428 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4429 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4430 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4431 ones.
4432
4433 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4434 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4435 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4436
4437 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4438 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4439 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4440 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4441 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4442
4443 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4444 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4445 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4446 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4447 the lack of any response.
4448
4449 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4450
4451 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4452 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4453 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4454
4455 Examples :
4456 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4457 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4458 backend https_relay
4459 mode tcp
4460 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4461 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4462
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004463 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4464 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4465 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004466
4467
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004468option httpclose
4469no option httpclose
4470 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4472 yes | yes | yes | yes
4473 Arguments : none
4474
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004475 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4476 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4477 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4478 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004479 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004480 "option http-tunnel".
4481
4482 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4483 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4484 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4485 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4486 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4487 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4488 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4489 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004490
4491 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004492 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004493 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4494 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4495 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4496 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4497 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004498
4499 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4500 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004501 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4502 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004503 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4504 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004505
4506 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4507 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4508
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004509 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4510 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004511
4512
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004513option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004514 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4516 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004517 Arguments :
4518 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4519 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4520 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4521 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4522 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004523
4524 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4525 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4526 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4527 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4528 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4529 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4530 ports.
4531
4532 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4533
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01004534 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
4535 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004536
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004537 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004538
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004539
4540option http_proxy
4541no option http_proxy
4542 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4544 yes | yes | yes | yes
4545 Arguments : none
4546
4547 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4548 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4549 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4550 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4551 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4552
4553 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4554 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4555 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4556 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004557 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004558 be analyzed.
4559
4560 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4561 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4562
4563 Example :
4564 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4565 backend direct_forward
4566 option httpclose
4567 option http_proxy
4568
4569 See also : "option httpclose"
4570
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004571
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004572option independent-streams
4573no option independent-streams
4574 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4576 yes | yes | yes | yes
4577 Arguments : none
4578
4579 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4580 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4581 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4582 receive data or not.
4583
4584 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4585 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4586 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4587 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4588 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4589 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4590 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4591 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4592 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4593 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4594 socket buffers.
4595
4596 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4597 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4598 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4599 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4600 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4601
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004602 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004603 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4604 deprecated.
4605
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004606 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004607
4608
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004609option ldap-check
4610 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4612 yes | no | yes | yes
4613 Arguments : none
4614
4615 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4616 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4617 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4618 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4619
4620 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4621 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4622
4623 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4624 configure it.
4625
4626 Example :
4627 option ldap-check
4628
4629 See also : "option httpchk"
4630
4631
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004632option external-check
4633 Use external processes for server health checks
4634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4635 yes | no | yes | yes
4636
4637 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
4638 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
4639 command".
4640
4641 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
4642
4643 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
4644
4645
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004646option log-health-checks
4647no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004648 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4650 yes | no | yes | yes
4651 Arguments : none
4652
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004653 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4654 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4655 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004656
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004657 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4658 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4659 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4660 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4661 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4662
4663 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4664 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004665
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004666 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4667 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4668 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004669
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004670
4671option log-separate-errors
4672no option log-separate-errors
4673 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4674 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4675 yes | yes | yes | no
4676 Arguments : none
4677
4678 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4679 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4680 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4681 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4682 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4683 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4684 provides very important information.
4685
4686 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4687 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4688 error logs.
4689
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004690 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004691 logging.
4692
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004693
4694option logasap
4695no option logasap
4696 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4698 yes | yes | yes | no
4699 Arguments : none
4700
4701 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4702 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4703 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4704 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4705 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4706 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4707 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004708 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004709 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4710 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4711
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004712 Examples :
4713 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4714 mode http
4715 option httplog
4716 option logasap
4717 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4718
4719 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4720 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4721 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4722 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004724 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004725 logging.
4726
4727
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004728option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004729 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4731 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004732 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004733 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4734 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004735 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004736
4737 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4738 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4739 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4740 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4741 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4742 in the MySQL table, like this :
4743
4744 USE mysql;
4745 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4746 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4747
4748 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4749 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4750 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4751 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4752 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4753 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4754 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4755 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4756 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4757
4758 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4759 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004760
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004761 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004762
4763 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4764 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4765 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4766 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4767 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4768 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4769
4770 See also: "option httpchk"
4771
4772
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004773option nolinger
4774no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004775 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004776 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4777 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004778 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004779
4780 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4781 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4782 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4783 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4784 connections.
4785
4786 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4787 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4788 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4789 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4790 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4791 this too.
4792
4793 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4794 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4795 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4796
4797 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4798 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4799 for servers.
4800
4801 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4802 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4803
4804
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004805option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4806 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4808 yes | yes | yes | yes
4809 Arguments :
4810 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4811 matching <network>
4812 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4813 header name.
4814
4815 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4816 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4817 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4818 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4819 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4820 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4821 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4822 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4823 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4824 possible that the client has already brought one.
4825
4826 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4827 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4828 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4829 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4830 header and requires different one.
4831
4832 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4833 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4834 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4835 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4836 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4837 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4838 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4839
4840 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4841 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4842 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4843 both are defined.
4844
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004845 Examples :
4846 # Original Destination address
4847 frontend www
4848 mode http
4849 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4850
4851 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4852 backend www
4853 mode http
4854 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4855
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004856 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4857 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004858
4859
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004860option persist
4861no option persist
4862 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4863 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4864 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004865 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004866
4867 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4868 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4869 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4870 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4871 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4872 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4873 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4874 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4875 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4876 redirected to another valid server.
4877
4878 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4879 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4880
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004881 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004882
4883
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004884option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4885 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4887 yes | no | yes | yes
4888 Arguments :
4889 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4890 PostgreSQL server.
4891
4892 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4893 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4894 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4895 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4896
4897 See also: "option httpchk"
4898
4899
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004900option prefer-last-server
4901no option prefer-last-server
4902 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4903 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4904 yes | no | yes | yes
4905 Arguments : none
4906
4907 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4908 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4909 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4910 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4911 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4912 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4913 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4914 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4915 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004916 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4917 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4918 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4919 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4920 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4921 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4922 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004923
4924 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4925 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4926
4927 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4928
4929
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004930option redispatch
4931no option redispatch
4932 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4933 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4934 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004935 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004936
4937 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4938 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4939 be able to access the service anymore.
4940
4941 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4942 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4943
4944 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4945 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4946 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004947
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004948 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4949 "redisp" keywords.
4950
4951 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4952 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4953
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004954 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004955
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004956
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004957option redis-check
4958 Use redis health checks for server testing
4959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4960 yes | no | yes | yes
4961 Arguments : none
4962
4963 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4964 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4965 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4966 find the "+PONG" response message.
4967
4968 Example :
4969 option redis-check
4970
4971 See also : "option httpchk"
4972
4973
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004974option smtpchk
4975option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4976 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4978 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004979 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004980 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4981 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4982 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4983
4984 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4985 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4986 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4987
4988 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4989 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4990 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4991 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4992 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4993 dead server.
4994
4995 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4996 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4997 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4998 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4999
5000 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
5001 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
5002 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5003 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
5004 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
5005
5006 Example :
5007 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
5008
5009 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
5010
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005011
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02005012option socket-stats
5013no option socket-stats
5014
5015 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
5016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5017 yes | yes | yes | no
5018
5019 Arguments : none
5020
5021
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005022option splice-auto
5023no option splice-auto
5024 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
5025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5026 yes | yes | yes | yes
5027 Arguments : none
5028
5029 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
5030 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
5031 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
5032 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005033 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005034 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
5035 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
5036 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
5037 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5038
5039 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
5040 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
5041 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
5042 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
5043 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
5044 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
5045 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
5046 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
5047 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
5048 keyword.
5049
5050 Example :
5051 option splice-auto
5052
5053 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5054 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5055
5056 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
5057 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5058
5059
5060option splice-request
5061no option splice-request
5062 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
5063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5064 yes | yes | yes | yes
5065 Arguments : none
5066
5067 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005068 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005069 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5070 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5071 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5072 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5073
5074 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5075
5076 Example :
5077 option splice-request
5078
5079 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5080 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5081
5082 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
5083 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5084
5085
5086option splice-response
5087no option splice-response
5088 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
5089 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5090 yes | yes | yes | yes
5091 Arguments : none
5092
5093 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005094 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01005095 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
5096 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
5097 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
5098 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
5099
5100 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
5101
5102 Example :
5103 option splice-response
5104
5105 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5106 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5107
5108 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
5109 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
5110
5111
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005112option srvtcpka
5113no option srvtcpka
5114 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
5115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5116 yes | no | yes | yes
5117 Arguments : none
5118
5119 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5120 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5121 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5122 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5123
5124 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5125 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5126 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5127 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5128
5129 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5130 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5131 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5132 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5133 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5134
5135 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5136
5137 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5138 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5139 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
5140
5141 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5142 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5143
5144 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
5145
5146
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005147option ssl-hello-chk
5148 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
5149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5150 yes | no | yes | yes
5151 Arguments : none
5152
5153 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
5154 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
5155 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
5156 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
5157 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
5158 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
5159 hello message.
5160
5161 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
5162 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
5163 messages, which is appreciable.
5164
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005165 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
5166 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
5167 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005168
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02005169 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
5170
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005171
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005172option tcp-check
5173 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
5174 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5175 yes | no | yes | yes
5176
5177 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
5178 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
5179
5180 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
5181 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
5182 attempt, which remains the default mode.
5183
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005184 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005185 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
5186 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
5187 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
5188 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
5189 only.
5190
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005191 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005192 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
5193 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
5194 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
5195 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
5196
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005197 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005198 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
5199 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005200 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005201 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
5202 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
5203 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
5204 the respective protocols.
5205 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
5206 analysed.
5207
5208 Examples :
5209 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
5210 option tcp-check
5211 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
5212
5213 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
5214 option tcp-check
5215 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
5216
5217 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
5218 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005219 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01005220 option tcp-check
5221 tcp-check send PING\r\n
5222 tcp-check expect +PONG
5223 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
5224 tcp-check expect string role:master
5225 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
5226 tcp-check expect string +OK
5227
5228 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
5229 (send many headers before analyzing)
5230 option tcp-check
5231 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
5232 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
5233 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
5234 tcp-check send \r\n
5235 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
5236
5237
5238 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
5239
5240
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005241option tcp-smart-accept
5242no option tcp-smart-accept
5243 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
5244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5245 yes | yes | yes | no
5246 Arguments : none
5247
5248 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
5249 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
5250 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
5251 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
5252 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
5253 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
5254
5255 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
5256 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
5257 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
5258 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
5259
5260 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
5261 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
5262 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
5263 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
5264
5265 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
5266 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5267 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5268
5269 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5270 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5271 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5272
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005273 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5274
5275
5276option tcp-smart-connect
5277no option tcp-smart-connect
5278 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5280 yes | no | yes | yes
5281 Arguments : none
5282
5283 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5284 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5285 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5286 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5287 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5288
5289 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5290 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5291 complex.
5292
5293 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5294 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5295 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5296
5297 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5298 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5299
5300 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5301
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005302
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005303option tcpka
5304 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5306 yes | yes | yes | yes
5307 Arguments : none
5308
5309 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5310 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5311 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5312 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5313
5314 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5315 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5316 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5317 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5318
5319 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5320 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5321 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5322 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5323 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5324
5325 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5326
5327 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5328 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5329 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5330 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5331 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5332 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5333 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5334 backends.
5335
5336 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5337
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005338
5339option tcplog
5340 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5342 yes | yes | yes | yes
5343 Arguments : none
5344
5345 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5346 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5347 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5348 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5349 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5350 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5351 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5352 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5353
5354 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5355
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005356 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005357
5358
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005359option transparent
5360no option transparent
5361 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005363 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005364 Arguments : none
5365
5366 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5367 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5368 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5369 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5370 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5371 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5372 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5373 appropriate server.
5374
5375 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5376 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5377
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005378 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005379 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005380
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005381
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005382external-check command <command>
5383 Executable to run when performing an external-check
5384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5385 yes | no | yes | yes
5386
5387 Arguments :
5388 <command> is the external command to run
5389
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005390 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
5391
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005392 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005393
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01005394 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
5395 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
5396 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
5397 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
5398 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
5399 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005400
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01005401 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
5402
5403 Environment variables :
5404 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
5405 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
5406
5407 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
5408
5409 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
5410
5411 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
5412 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
5413 for a UNIX socket).
5414
5415 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
5416
5417 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
5418
5419 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
5420
5421 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
5422
5423 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
5424
5425 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
5426 socket).
5427
5428 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
5429 the command may be set using "external-check path".
5430
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005431 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
5432 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
5433 failed.
5434
5435 Example :
5436 external-check command /bin/true
5437
5438 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
5439
5440
5441external-check path <path>
5442 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
5443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5444 yes | no | yes | yes
5445
5446 Arguments :
5447 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
5448
5449 The default path is "".
5450
5451 Example :
5452 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
5453
5454 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
5455 "external-check command"
5456
5457
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005458persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005459persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005460 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5462 yes | no | yes | yes
5463 Arguments :
5464 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005465 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5466 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005467
5468 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5469 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5470 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5471 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5472 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5473 forwarded to this server.
5474
5475 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5476 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5477 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005478 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005479 a single "listen" section.
5480
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005481 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5482 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5483 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5484
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005485 Example :
5486 listen tse-farm
5487 bind :3389
5488 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5489 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5490 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5491 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5492 persist rdp-cookie
5493 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005494 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005495 balance rdp-cookie
5496 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5497 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5498
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005499 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5500 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005501
5502
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005503rate-limit sessions <rate>
5504 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5506 yes | yes | yes | no
5507 Arguments :
5508 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5509 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5510
5511 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5512 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5513 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5514 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5515 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5516 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5517
5518 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5519 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5520 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5521 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5522
5523 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5524 listen smtp
5525 mode tcp
5526 bind :25
5527 rate-limit sessions 10
5528 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5529
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005530 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5531 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5532 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005533
5534 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5535
5536
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005537redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5538redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5539redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005540 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5542 no | yes | yes | yes
5543
5544 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005545 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005546
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005547 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005548 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005549 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5550 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5551 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005552
5553 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5554 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5555 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5556 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5557 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005558 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5559 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5560 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5561 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005562
5563 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5564 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5565 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5566 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5567 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5568 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005569 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005570 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005571 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5572 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5573 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005574
5575 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005576 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5577 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5578 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5579 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5580 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5581 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5582 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5583 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005584
5585 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5586 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5587
5588 - "drop-query"
5589 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5590 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5591 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5592 with a location-type redirect.
5593
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005594 - "append-slash"
5595 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5596 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5597 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5598 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5599
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005600 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5601 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5602 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5603 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5604 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5605 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5606 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5607
5608 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5609 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5610 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5611 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5612 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5613 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5614 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005615
5616 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5617 acl clear dst_port 80
5618 acl secure dst_port 8080
5619 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005620 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005621 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005622 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5623
5624 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005625 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5626 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5627 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005628 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005629
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005630 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5631 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5632 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5633
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005634 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005635 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005636
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005637 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5638 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5639 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5640
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005641 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005642
5643
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005644redisp (deprecated)
5645redispatch (deprecated)
5646 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5647 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5648 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005649 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005650
5651 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5652 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5653 be able to access the service anymore.
5654
5655 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5656 redistribute them to a working server.
5657
5658 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5659 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5660 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005661
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005662 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5663 "option redispatch" instead.
5664
5665 See also : "option redispatch"
5666
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005667
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005668reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005669 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5671 no | yes | yes | yes
5672 Arguments :
5673 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5674 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005675 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005676
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005677 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5678 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5679
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005680 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5681 the last header of an HTTP request.
5682
5683 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5684 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5685 responses.
5686
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005687 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5688 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5689 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5690
5691 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5692 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005693
5694
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005695reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5696reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005697 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5699 no | yes | yes | yes
5700 Arguments :
5701 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5702 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5703 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5704 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5705 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5706 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5707 ignores case.
5708
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005709 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5710 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5711
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005712 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5713 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5714 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5715 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005716 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005717
5718 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5719 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5720
5721 Example :
5722 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5723 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5724 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5725
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005726 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5727 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005728
5729
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005730reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5731reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005732 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5733 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5734 no | yes | yes | yes
5735 Arguments :
5736 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5737 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5738 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5739 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5740 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5741 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5742
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005743 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5744 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5745
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005746 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5747 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5748 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5749 next servers.
5750
5751 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5752 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5753 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5754
5755 Example :
5756 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5757 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5758 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5759
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005760 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5761 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005762
5763
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005764reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5765reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005766 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5768 no | yes | yes | yes
5769 Arguments :
5770 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5771 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5772 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5773 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5774 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5775 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5776 case.
5777
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005778 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5779 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5780
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005781 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5782 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5783 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5784 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005785 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005786
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005787 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005788 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005789 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005790
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005791 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5792 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5793
5794 Example :
5795 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5796 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5797 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5798
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005799 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5800 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005801
5802
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005803reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5804reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005805 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5807 no | yes | yes | yes
5808 Arguments :
5809 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5810 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5811 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5812 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5813 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5814 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5815 case.
5816
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005817 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5818 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5819
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005820 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5821 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5822 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5823 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5824
5825 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5826 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5827
5828 Example :
5829 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5830 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5831 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5832 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5833
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005834 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5835 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005836
5837
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005838reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5839reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005840 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5842 no | yes | yes | yes
5843 Arguments :
5844 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5845 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5846 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5847 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5848 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5849 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5850
5851 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5852 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5853 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5854 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005855 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005856
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005857 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5858 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5859
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005860 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5861 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5862 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5863
5864 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5865 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5866 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5867 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5868 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5869
5870 Example :
5871 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005872 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005873 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5874 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5875
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005876 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5877 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005878
5879
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005880reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5881reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005882 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5884 no | yes | yes | yes
5885 Arguments :
5886 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5887 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5888 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5889 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5890 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5891 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5892 ignores case.
5893
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005894 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5895 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5896
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005897 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5898 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005899 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5900 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5901 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005902 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5903 not set.
5904
5905 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5906 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5907 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5908 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5909 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5910
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005911 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005912 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5913 # block all others.
5914 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5915 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5916
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005917 # block bad guys
5918 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5919 reqitarpit . if badguys
5920
5921 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5922 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005923
5924
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005925retries <value>
5926 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5927 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5928 yes | no | yes | yes
5929 Arguments :
5930 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5931 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5932 default value is 3.
5933
5934 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5935 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5936 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5937
5938 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5939 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5940
5941 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5942 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5943
5944 See also : "option redispatch"
5945
5946
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005947rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005948 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5950 no | yes | yes | yes
5951 Arguments :
5952 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5953 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005954 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005955
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005956 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5957 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5958
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005959 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5960 the last header of an HTTP response.
5961
5962 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5963 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5964 responses.
5965
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005966 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5967 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005968
5969
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005970rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5971rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005972 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5974 no | yes | yes | yes
5975 Arguments :
5976 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5977 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5978 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5979 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5980 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5981 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5982 ignores case.
5983
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005984 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5985 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5986
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005987 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5988 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005989 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005990 client.
5991
5992 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5993 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5994 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5995
5996 Example :
5997 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005998 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005999
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006000 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
6001 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006002
6003
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006004rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6005rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006006 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
6007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6008 no | yes | yes | yes
6009 Arguments :
6010 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6011 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6012 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6013 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6014 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6015 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
6016 ignores case.
6017
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006018 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6019 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6020
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006021 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6022 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
6023 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
6024 case-sensitive.
6025
6026 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006027 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
6028 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
6029 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006030
6031 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6032 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
6033
6034 Example :
6035 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
6036 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
6037
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006038 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
6039 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006040
6041
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006042rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6043rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006044 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
6045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6046 no | yes | yes | yes
6047 Arguments :
6048 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6049 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
6050 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
6051 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
6052 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
6053 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
6054 ignores case.
6055
6056 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6057 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6058 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6059 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006060 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006061
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006062 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6063 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6064
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006065 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
6066 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
6067 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
6068
6069 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6070 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6071 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6072 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
6073 are not case-sensitive.
6074
6075 Example :
6076 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
6077 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
6078
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01006079 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
6080 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006081
6082
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006083server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006084 Declare a server in a backend
6085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6086 no | no | yes | yes
6087 Arguments :
6088 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02006089 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006090 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006091
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01006092 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
6093 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
6094 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
6095 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02006096 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
6097 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
6098 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
6099 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
6100 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006101 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
6102 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
6103 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
6104 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
6105 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6106 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6107 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006108 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006109 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6110 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6111 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6112 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006113
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02006114 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006115 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
6116 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
6117 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
6118 adding this value to the client's port.
6119
6120 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
6121 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006122 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006123
6124 Examples :
6125 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
6126 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006127 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006128 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
6129 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
6130 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006131
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006132 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
6133 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006134
6135
6136source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006137source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006138source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006139 Set the source address for outgoing connections
6140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6141 yes | no | yes | yes
6142 Arguments :
6143 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
6144 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006145
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006146 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01006147 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
6148 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
6149 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
6150 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
6151 supported prefixes are :
6152 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
6153 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
6154 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02006155 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006156 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
6157 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
6158 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
6159 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006160
6161 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
6162 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006163 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
6164 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
6165 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006166
6167 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
6168 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
6169 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
6170 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
6171 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
6172 <addr>.
6173
6174 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
6175 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
6176 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
6177 port.
6178
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006179 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
6180 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
6181 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
6182 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01006183 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006184 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
6185 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
6186 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
6187 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
6188 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
6189 HTTP header.
6190
6191 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
6192 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006193 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006194 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
6195 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
6196 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
6197 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
6198 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
6199 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
6200 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
6201
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01006202 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
6203 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
6204 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
6205 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
6206 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
6207 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
6208
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006209 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
6210 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
6211 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
6212 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
6213
6214 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
6215 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
6216 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
6217 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
6218 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
6219 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
6220
6221 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
6222 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
6223 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
6224 there are two methods :
6225
6226 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
6227 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
6228 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
6229 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
6230 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
6231 of the client ranges may be used.
6232
6233 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
6234 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
6235 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
6236 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
6237 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
6238 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
6239 same session.
6240
6241 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
6242 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
6243 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
6244 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
6245 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
6246 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
6247
6248 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
6249 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
6250 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006251 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006252
6253 Examples :
6254 backend private
6255 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
6256 source 192.168.1.200
6257
6258 backend transparent_ssl1
6259 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
6260 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6261
6262 backend transparent_ssl2
6263 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
6264 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
6265 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
6266
6267 backend transparent_ssl3
6268 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
6269 # is more conntrack-friendly.
6270 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
6271
6272 backend transparent_smtp
6273 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
6274 # with Tproxy version 4.
6275 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
6276
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006277 backend transparent_http
6278 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
6279 # proxy.
6280 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
6281
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006282 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006283 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
6284
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006285
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006286srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
6287 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
6288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6289 yes | no | yes | yes
6290 Arguments :
6291 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
6292 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
6293 as explained at the top of this document.
6294
6295 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
6296 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
6297 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
6298 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
6299 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
6300 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
6301 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
6302
6303 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
6304 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
6305 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
6306 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
6307 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006308 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006309 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006310 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006311
6312 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
6313 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
6314 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
6315 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
6316 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
6317 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
6318
6319 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
6320 Please use "timeout server" instead.
6321
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006322 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
6323 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006324
6325
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006326stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
6327 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
6328 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006329 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006330
6331 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
6332 matched.
6333
6334 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
6335 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
6336
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006337 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6338 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6339 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6340
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01006341 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
6342 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6343 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6344 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006345
6346 Example :
6347 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6348 backend stats_localhost
6349 stats enable
6350 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6351
6352 Example :
6353 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6354 backend stats_auth
6355 stats enable
6356 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6357 stats admin if TRUE
6358
6359 Example :
6360 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6361 userlist stats-auth
6362 group admin users admin
6363 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6364 group readonly users haproxy
6365 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6366
6367 backend stats_auth
6368 stats enable
6369 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6370 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6371 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6372 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6373
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006374 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6375 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6376 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006377
6378
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006379stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6380 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006382 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006383 Arguments :
6384 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6385
6386 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6387
6388 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6389 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6390 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6391 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6392 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6393 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6394
6395 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6396 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6397 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006398 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006399
6400 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6401 report using "stats scope".
6402
6403 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6404 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6405 unobvious parameters.
6406
6407 Example :
6408 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6409 backend public_www
6410 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6411 stats enable
6412 stats hide-version
6413 stats scope .
6414 stats uri /admin?stats
6415 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6416 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6417 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6418
6419 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6420 backend private_monitoring
6421 stats enable
6422 stats uri /admin?stats
6423 stats refresh 5s
6424
6425 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6426
6427
6428stats enable
6429 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006431 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006432 Arguments : none
6433
6434 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6435 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6436 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6437 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6438 - stats auth : no authentication
6439 - stats scope : no restriction
6440
6441 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6442 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6443 unobvious parameters.
6444
6445 Example :
6446 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6447 backend public_www
6448 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6449 stats enable
6450 stats hide-version
6451 stats scope .
6452 stats uri /admin?stats
6453 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6454 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6455 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6456
6457 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6458 backend private_monitoring
6459 stats enable
6460 stats uri /admin?stats
6461 stats refresh 5s
6462
6463 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6464
6465
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006466stats hide-version
6467 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006469 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006470 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006471
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006472 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6473 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6474 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6475 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6476 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6477 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006478
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006479 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6480 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6481 unobvious parameters.
6482
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006483 Example :
6484 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6485 backend public_www
6486 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006487 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006488 stats hide-version
6489 stats scope .
6490 stats uri /admin?stats
6491 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6492 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6493 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006494
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006495 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6496 backend private_monitoring
6497 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006498 stats uri /admin?stats
6499 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006500
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006501 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006502
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006503
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006504stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6505 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6506 Access control for statistics
6507
6508 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6509 no | no | yes | yes
6510
6511 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6512 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6513 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6514 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6515 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6516 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6517
6518 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6519 instance.
6520
6521 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6522 about ACL usage.
6523
6524
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006525stats realm <realm>
6526 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006528 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006529 Arguments :
6530 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6531 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6532 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6533
6534 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6535 using a backslash ('\').
6536
6537 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6538 only related to authentication.
6539
6540 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6541 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6542 unobvious parameters.
6543
6544 Example :
6545 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6546 backend public_www
6547 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6548 stats enable
6549 stats hide-version
6550 stats scope .
6551 stats uri /admin?stats
6552 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6553 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6554 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6555
6556 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6557 backend private_monitoring
6558 stats enable
6559 stats uri /admin?stats
6560 stats refresh 5s
6561
6562 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6563
6564
6565stats refresh <delay>
6566 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006568 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006569 Arguments :
6570 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6571 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6572 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6573 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6574 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6575 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6576
6577 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6578 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6579 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6580 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6581
6582 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6583 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6584 unobvious parameters.
6585
6586 Example :
6587 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6588 backend public_www
6589 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6590 stats enable
6591 stats hide-version
6592 stats scope .
6593 stats uri /admin?stats
6594 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6595 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6596 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6597
6598 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6599 backend private_monitoring
6600 stats enable
6601 stats uri /admin?stats
6602 stats refresh 5s
6603
6604 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6605
6606
6607stats scope { <name> | "." }
6608 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006610 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006611 Arguments :
6612 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6613 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6614 section in which the statement appears.
6615
6616 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6617 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6618 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6619 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6620 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6621 exists.
6622
6623 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6624 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6625 unobvious parameters.
6626
6627 Example :
6628 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6629 backend public_www
6630 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6631 stats enable
6632 stats hide-version
6633 stats scope .
6634 stats uri /admin?stats
6635 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6636 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6637 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6638
6639 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6640 backend private_monitoring
6641 stats enable
6642 stats uri /admin?stats
6643 stats refresh 5s
6644
6645 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6646
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006647
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006648stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006649 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006651 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006652
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006653 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006654 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6655
6656 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6657 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6658
6659 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6660 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006661 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006662
6663 Example :
6664 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6665 backend private_monitoring
6666 stats enable
6667 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6668 stats uri /admin?stats
6669 stats refresh 5s
6670
6671 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6672 global section.
6673
6674
6675stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006676 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6678 yes | yes | yes | yes
6679 Arguments : none
6680
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006681 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006682 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6683 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6684 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6685 - IP (socket, server)
6686 - cookie (backend, server)
6687
6688 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6689 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006690 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006691
6692 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6693
6694
6695stats show-node [ <name> ]
6696 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006698 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006699 Arguments:
6700 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6701 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6702
6703 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6704 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006705 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006706
6707 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6708 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6709 unobvious parameters.
6710
6711 Example:
6712 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6713 backend private_monitoring
6714 stats enable
6715 stats show-node Europe-1
6716 stats uri /admin?stats
6717 stats refresh 5s
6718
6719 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6720 section.
6721
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006722
6723stats uri <prefix>
6724 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006726 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006727 Arguments :
6728 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6729 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6730 query string.
6731
6732 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6733 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6734 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6735 possible to reach it in the application.
6736
6737 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006738 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006739 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6740 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6741 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6742 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6743
6744 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6745 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6746 an address or a port to statistics only.
6747
6748 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6749 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6750 unobvious parameters.
6751
6752 Example :
6753 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6754 backend public_www
6755 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6756 stats enable
6757 stats hide-version
6758 stats scope .
6759 stats uri /admin?stats
6760 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6761 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6762 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6763
6764 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6765 backend private_monitoring
6766 stats enable
6767 stats uri /admin?stats
6768 stats refresh 5s
6769
6770 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6771
6772
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006773stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6774 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006776 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006777
6778 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006779 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006780 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6781 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6782 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6783
6784 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6785 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6786 the "stick-table" statement.
6787
6788 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6789 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6790 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6791 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6792 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6793
6794 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6795 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6796 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6797 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6798 transformation rules.
6799
6800 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6801 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6802 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6803 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6804 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6805 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6806 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6807
6808 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6809 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6810 ACL based conditions.
6811
6812 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6813 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6814 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6815 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6816
6817 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6818 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6819 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6820 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6821
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006822 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6823 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6824 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6825
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006826 Example :
6827 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6828 # last 30 minutes
6829 backend pop
6830 mode tcp
6831 balance roundrobin
6832 stick store-request src
6833 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6834 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6835 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6836
6837 backend smtp
6838 mode tcp
6839 balance roundrobin
6840 stick match src table pop
6841 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6842 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6843
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006844 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006845 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006846
6847
6848stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6849 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6851 no | no | yes | yes
6852
6853 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6854 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6855 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6856 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6857
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006858 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6859 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6860 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6861
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006862 Examples :
6863 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006864 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006865
6866 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6867 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6868 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6869
6870
6871 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6872 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6873 backend http
6874 mode http
6875 balance roundrobin
6876 stick on src table https
6877 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6878 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6879 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6880
6881 backend https
6882 mode tcp
6883 balance roundrobin
6884 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6885 stick on src
6886 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6887 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6888
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006889 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006890
6891
6892stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6893 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6895 no | no | yes | yes
6896
6897 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006898 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006899 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6900 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6901 server is selected.
6902
6903 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6904 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6905 the "stick-table" statement.
6906
6907 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6908 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6909 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6910 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6911 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6912 address.
6913
6914 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6915 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6916 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6917 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6918 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6919 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6920 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6921 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6922 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6923 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6924
6925 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6926 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6927 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6928 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6929 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6930 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6931 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6932
6933 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6934 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6935 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6936 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6937
6938 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6939 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6940 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6941 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6942 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6943 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006944 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6945 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6946 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6947 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6948 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6949 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006950
6951 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6952 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6953 the request.
6954
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006955 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6956 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6957 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6958
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006959 Example :
6960 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6961 # last 30 minutes
6962 backend pop
6963 mode tcp
6964 balance roundrobin
6965 stick store-request src
6966 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6967 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6968 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6969
6970 backend smtp
6971 mode tcp
6972 balance roundrobin
6973 stick match src table pop
6974 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6975 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6976
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006977 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02006978 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006979
6980
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006981stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006982 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6983 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006984 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006986 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006987
6988 Arguments :
6989 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6990 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6991 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6992 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6993
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006994 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6995 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6996 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6997 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6998
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006999 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
7000 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
7001 instance.
7002
7003 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
7004 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
7005 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
7006 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
7007 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
7008 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007009 to 32 characters.
7010
7011 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
7012 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
7013 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007014 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007015 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
7016 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007017
7018 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02007019 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
7020 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007021 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
7022 increase.
7023
7024 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007025 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
7026 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
7027 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007028
7029 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
7030 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
7031 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
7032 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
7033 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
7034 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
7035 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
7036 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
7037 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
7038 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
7039 parameter (see below).
7040
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02007041 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
7042 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
7043 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
7044 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
7045 soft restart.
7046
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007047 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
7048
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007049 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
7050 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
7051 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
7052 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
7053 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007054 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007055 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
7056 if not expiration delay is specified.
7057
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007058 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
7059 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
7060 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
7061 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007062 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
7063 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
7064 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
7065 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
7066 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
7067 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
7068 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
7069 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
7070 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
7071 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
7072 types and their arguments.
7073
7074 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
7075 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
7076 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
7077 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
7078
7079 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
7080 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
7081 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
7082 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
7083
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02007084 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
7085 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
7086 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
7087 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
7088 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
7089 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
7090
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007091 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7092 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
7093 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
7094 they were received.
7095
7096 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7097 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
7098 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
7099 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
7100 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
7101
7102 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7103 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7104 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7105 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
7106 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7107
7108 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
7109 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
7110 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
7111
7112 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7113 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7114 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7115 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
7116 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7117
7118 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7119 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
7120 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
7121 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
7122 the client side.
7123
7124 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7125 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7126 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7127 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
7128 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
7129 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
7130 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
7131
7132 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
7133 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
7134 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
7135 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
7136 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
7137 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
7138 (eg: vulnerability scan).
7139
7140 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7141 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7142 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7143 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
7144 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
7145 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
7146
7147 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7148 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
7149 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
7150 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
7151
7152 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
7153 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7154 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7155 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7156 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7157 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
7158 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
7159 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
7160 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
7161 recommended for better fairness.
7162
7163 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
7164 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
7165 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
7166 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
7167
7168 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
7169 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
7170 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
7171 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
7172 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
7173 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
7174 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
7175 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
7176 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
7177 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02007178
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02007179 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
7180 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007181 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
7182 reference it.
7183
7184 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
7185 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
7186 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
7187 as an exclusive stickiness.
7188
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007189 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
7190 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
7191 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
7192 something that can be ignored.
7193
7194 Example:
7195 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
7196 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
7197 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
7198 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
7199
7200 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01007201 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007202
7203
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007204stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7205 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
7206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7207 no | no | yes | yes
7208
7209 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007210 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007211 describes what elements of the response or connection will
7212 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
7213 server is selected.
7214
7215 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7216 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7217 the "stick-table" statement.
7218
7219 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
7220 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
7221 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
7222 when the response is a SSL server hello.
7223
7224 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7225 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
7226 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
7227 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
7228 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
7229 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007230 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007231 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
7232 rules.
7233
7234 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7235 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7236 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7237 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7238 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7239 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7240 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7241
7242 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
7243 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
7244 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
7245 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
7246
7247 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
7248 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
7249 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
7250 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
7251 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
7252 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01007253 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
7254 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
7255 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
7256 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
7257 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
7258 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
7259 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
7260 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
7261 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007262
7263 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
7264
7265 Example :
7266 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
7267 backend https
7268 mode tcp
7269 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007270 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007271 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007272
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007273 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
7274 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
7275
7276 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
7277 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7278 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
7279
7280 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
7281 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007282
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007283 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
7284 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
7285 # at offset 44.
7286
7287 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
7288 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
7289
7290 # Learn on response if server hello.
7291 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007292
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02007293 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
7294 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
7295
7296 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
7297 extraction.
7298
7299
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02007300tcp-check connect [params*]
7301 Opens a new connection
7302 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7303 no | no | yes | yes
7304
7305 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
7306 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
7307 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
7308
7309 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
7310 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
7311 of the sequence.
7312
7313 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
7314 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
7315 do.
7316
7317 Parameters :
7318 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
7319 use the TCP connection.
7320
7321 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
7322 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
7323 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
7324
7325 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
7326
7327 ssl opens a ciphered connection
7328
7329 Examples:
7330 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
7331 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
7332 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
7333 option tcp-check
7334 tcp-check connect
7335 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7336 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7337 tcp-check send \r\n
7338 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7339 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
7340 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
7341 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
7342 tcp-check send \r\n
7343 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7344 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7345
7346 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7347 option tcp-check
7348 tcp-check connect port 110
7349 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7350 tcp-check connect port 143
7351 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7352 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7353
7354 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7355
7356
7357tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7358 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7359 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7360 no | no | yes | yes
7361
7362 Arguments :
7363 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7364 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7365 binary.
7366 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7367 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7368 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7369
7370 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7371 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7372 with the usual backslash ('\').
7373 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7374 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7375 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7376 used upper or lower case.
7377
7378
7379 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7380
7381 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7382 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7383 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7384 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7385 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7386 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7387 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7388 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7389
7390 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7391 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7392 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7393 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7394 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7395 expression.
7396
7397 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7398 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7399 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7400 this exact hexadecimal string.
7401 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7402
7403 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7404 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7405 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7406 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7407 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7408 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7409 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7410 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7411 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7412 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7413 the null character.
7414
7415 Examples :
7416 # perform a POP check
7417 option tcp-check
7418 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7419
7420 # perform an IMAP check
7421 option tcp-check
7422 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7423
7424 # look for the redis master server
7425 option tcp-check
7426 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7427 tcp-check expect +PONG
7428 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7429 tcp-check expect string role:master
7430 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7431 tcp-check expect string +OK
7432
7433
7434 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7435 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7436
7437
7438tcp-check send <data>
7439 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7440 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7441 no | no | yes | yes
7442
7443 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7444 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7445
7446 Examples :
7447 # look for the redis master server
7448 option tcp-check
7449 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7450 tcp-check expect string role:master
7451
7452 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7453 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7454
7455
7456tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7457 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7458 tcp health check
7459 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7460 no | no | yes | yes
7461
7462 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7463 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7464 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7465 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7466 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7467 hexadecimal string.
7468 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7469
7470 Examples :
7471 # redis check in binary
7472 option tcp-check
7473 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7474 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7475
7476
7477 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7478 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7479
7480
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007481tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7482 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7484 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007485 Arguments :
7486 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007487 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7488 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007489
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007490 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007491
7492 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7493 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007494 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7495 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7496 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7497 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7498 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7499 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007500
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007501 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7502 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7503 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7504 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007505
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007506 Five types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007507 - accept :
7508 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7509 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7510 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007511
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007512 - reject :
7513 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7514 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7515 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7516 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7517 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7518 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7519 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7520 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7521 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7522 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7523 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7524 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007525
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007526 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7527 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7528 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7529 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7530 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7531 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7532 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7533 hosts.
7534
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007535 - capture <sample> len <length> :
7536 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
7537 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
7538 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
7539 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
7540 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
7541 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
7542 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
7543 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
7544 session life. Since it applies to Please check section 7.3 (Fetching
7545 samples) and "capture request header" for more information.
7546
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007547 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007548 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007549 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007550 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007551 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7552 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007553 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007554 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7555 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7556 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7557 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7558 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007559
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007560 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007561 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007562 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007563 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7564 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7565 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7566 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007567
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007568 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7569 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7570 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7571 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007572
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007573 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7574 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7575 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7576 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7577 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007578 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7579 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7580 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7581 layer7 information is extracted.
7582
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007583 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7584 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7585 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7586 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7587 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007588
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007589 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7590 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7591 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007592
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007593 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7594 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7595 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007596
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007597 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007598 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007599 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007600
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007601 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7602 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7603 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007604
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007605 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007606 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7607 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007608
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007609 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7610
7611 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7612
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007613 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7614
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007615 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007616
7617
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007618tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7619 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007621 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007622 Arguments :
7623 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007624 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007625 "track-sc2" and "capture". See "tcp-request connection" above
7626 for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007627
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007628 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007629
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007630 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7631 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7632 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7633 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7634 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007635
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007636 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7637 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7638 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7639 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007640 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7641 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7642 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7643 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7644 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7645 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007646 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007647 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007648
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007649 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7650 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7651 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7652 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007653
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02007654 Four types of actions are supported :
7655 - accept : the request is accepted
7656 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
7657 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007658 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007659
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007660 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7661 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007662
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007663 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7664 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7665 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7666 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7667 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7668 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007669
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007670 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007671 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7672 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007673
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007674 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007675 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7676 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7677 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7678 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007679 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7680 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7681 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007682
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007683 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007684 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
7685 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
7686 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007687
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007688 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007689 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7690 # and reject everything else.
7691 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7692 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007693 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007694 tcp-request content reject
7695
7696 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007697 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7698 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7699 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007700 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007701
7702 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7703 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7704 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007705 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007706 tcp-request content reject
7707
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007708 Example:
7709 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7710 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007711 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007712
7713 Example:
7714 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7715 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02007716 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007717
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007718 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7719 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7720
7721 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007722 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007723 # protecting all our sites
7724 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007725 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7726 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007727 ...
7728 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7729
7730 backend http_dynamic
7731 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007732 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007733 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007734 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7735 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7736 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007737 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007738
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007739 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007740
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007741 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007742
7743
7744tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7745 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007747 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007748 Arguments :
7749 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7750 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7751 as explained at the top of this document.
7752
7753 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7754 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7755 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7756 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7757 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7758
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007759 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7760 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7761 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7762 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7763
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007764 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7765 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007766 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007767 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007768 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7769 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7770 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7771 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007772
7773 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7774 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7775 it pass through unaffected.
7776
7777 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7778 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7779 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007780 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007781 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7782 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007783 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7784 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7785 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007786
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007787 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007788 "timeout client".
7789
7790
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007791tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7792 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7794 no | no | yes | yes
7795 Arguments :
7796 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007797 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007798
7799 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7800
7801 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7802 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7803 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007804 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7805 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007806
7807 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7808
7809 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7810 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7811 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7812 inserted.
7813
7814 Two types of actions are supported :
7815 - accept :
7816 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7817 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7818 the rules evaluation.
7819
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007820 - close :
7821 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7822 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7823 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7824 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7825 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7826 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007827 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007828 protocols.
7829
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007830 - reject :
7831 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7832 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007833 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007834
7835 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7836 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7837 for changing the default action to a reject.
7838
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007839 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7840 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7841 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7842 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007843 period.
7844
7845 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7846
7847 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7848
7849
7850tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7851 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7853 no | no | yes | yes
7854 Arguments :
7855 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7856 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7857 as explained at the top of this document.
7858
7859 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7860
7861
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007862timeout check <timeout>
7863 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7864 established.
7865
7866 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7867 yes | no | yes | yes
7868 Arguments:
7869 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7870 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7871 as explained at the top of this document.
7872
7873 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7874 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7875 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7876 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007877 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7878 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7879 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007880
7881 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7882 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7883
7884 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7885 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007886 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007887
7888 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7889 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7890 forget about it.
7891
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007892 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7893 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007894
7895
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007896timeout client <timeout>
7897timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7898 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7900 yes | yes | yes | no
7901 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007902 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007903 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7904 as explained at the top of this document.
7905
7906 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7907 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7908 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7909 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7910 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7911 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7912 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7913 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007914 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007915 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007916 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7917 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007918 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
7919 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007920
7921 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7922 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7923 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7924 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7925 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7926 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7927
7928 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7929 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7930 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7931
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007932 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007933
7934
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007935timeout client-fin <timeout>
7936 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
7937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7938 yes | yes | yes | no
7939 Arguments :
7940 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7941 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7942 as explained at the top of this document.
7943
7944 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7945 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7946 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7947 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7948 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
7949 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7950 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7951 down in one direction.
7952
7953 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7954 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7955 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
7956
7957 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
7958
7959
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007960timeout connect <timeout>
7961timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7962 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7964 yes | no | yes | yes
7965 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007966 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007967 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7968 as explained at the top of this document.
7969
7970 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007971 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007972 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007973 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007974 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7975 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007976
7977 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7978 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7979 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7980 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7981 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7982 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7983
7984 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7985 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7986 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7987
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007988 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7989 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007990
7991
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007992timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7993 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7995 yes | yes | yes | yes
7996 Arguments :
7997 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7998 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7999 as explained at the top of this document.
8000
8001 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
8002 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
8003 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
8004 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
8005 once the request has started to present itself.
8006
8007 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
8008 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
8009 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
8010 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
8011 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
8012
8013 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
8014 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
8015 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
8016 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
8017
8018 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
8019 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
8020 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
8021 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
8022 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02008023 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008024
8025 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
8026 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
8027 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
8028 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
8029
8030 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
8031
8032
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008033timeout http-request <timeout>
8034 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
8035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008036 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008037 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008038 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008039 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8040 as explained at the top of this document.
8041
8042 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
8043 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
8044 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
8045 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
8046 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
8047 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
8048 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02008049 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
8050 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
8051 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
8052 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
8053 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
8054 code using "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See more details in the explanations of
8055 the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008056
8057 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
8058 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008059 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
8060 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008061
8062 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
8063 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
8064 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
8065 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
8066 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
8067
8068 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02008069 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
8070 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
8071 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008072
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02008073 See also : "errorfile", "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008074
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008075
8076timeout queue <timeout>
8077 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
8078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8079 yes | no | yes | yes
8080 Arguments :
8081 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8082 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8083 as explained at the top of this document.
8084
8085 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
8086 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
8087 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
8088 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
8089 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
8090
8091 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
8092 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
8093 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
8094 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
8095
8096 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8097
8098
8099timeout server <timeout>
8100timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8101 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8103 yes | no | yes | yes
8104 Arguments :
8105 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8106 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8107 as explained at the top of this document.
8108
8109 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8110 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8111 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8112 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8113 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8114 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8115 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8116
8117 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8118 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8119 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8120 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8121 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008122 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008123 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008124 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
8125 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
8126 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
8127 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008128
8129 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8130 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8131 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8132 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8133 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8134 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8135
8136 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
8137 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
8138 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
8139
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008140 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008141
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008142
8143timeout server-fin <timeout>
8144 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
8145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8146 yes | no | yes | yes
8147 Arguments :
8148 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8149 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8150 as explained at the top of this document.
8151
8152 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8153 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
8154 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
8155 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
8156 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
8157 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
8158 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
8159 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
8160 situations, it should not be needed.
8161
8162 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8163 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
8164 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
8165
8166 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
8167
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008168
8169timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008170 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8172 yes | yes | yes | yes
8173 Arguments :
8174 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
8175 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8176 as explained at the top of this document.
8177
8178 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
8179 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
8180 defines how long it will be maintained open.
8181
8182 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8183 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8184 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
8185 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008186 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008187
8188 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
8189
8190
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008191timeout tunnel <timeout>
8192 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
8193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8194 yes | no | yes | yes
8195 Arguments :
8196 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8197 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8198 as explained at the top of this document.
8199
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008200 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008201 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
8202 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
8203 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
8204 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
8205 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
8206 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
8207 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
8208 specified.
8209
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008210 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
8211 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
8212 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
8213 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
8214 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
8215 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
8216 state.
8217
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008218 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8219 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8220 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
8221 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
8222 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
8223
8224 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8225 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8226 forget about it.
8227
8228 Example :
8229 defaults http
8230 option http-server-close
8231 timeout connect 5s
8232 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008233 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008234 timeout server 30s
8235 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
8236
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02008237 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008238
8239
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008240transparent (deprecated)
8241 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008243 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008244 Arguments : none
8245
8246 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
8247 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8248 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8249 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8250 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8251 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8252 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8253 appropriate server.
8254
8255 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
8256
8257 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8258 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8259
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008260 See also: "option transparent"
8261
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008262unique-id-format <string>
8263 Generate a unique ID for each request.
8264 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8265 yes | yes | yes | no
8266 Arguments :
8267 <string> is a log-format string.
8268
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008269 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
8270 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
8271 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
8272 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008273
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008274 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
8275 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
8276 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
8277 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
8278 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
8279 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
8280 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
8281 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008282
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008283 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
8284 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008285
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008286 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008287
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008288 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008289
8290 will generate:
8291
8292 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8293
8294 See also: "unique-id-header"
8295
8296unique-id-header <name>
8297 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
8298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8299 yes | yes | yes | no
8300 Arguments :
8301 <name> is the name of the header.
8302
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008303 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
8304 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008305
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008306 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008307
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05008308 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01008309 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
8310
8311 will generate:
8312
8313 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
8314
8315 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008316
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008317use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008318 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8320 no | yes | yes | no
8321 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008322 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
8323 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008324
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02008325 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
8326 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008327
8328 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
8329 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
8330 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02008331 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
8332 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
8333 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
8334 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008335
8336 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
8337 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
8338 assign the backend.
8339
8340 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
8341 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8342 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
8343 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
8344 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
8345 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
8346
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008347 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008348 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02008349 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
8350 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
8351 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
8352
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008353 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
8354 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
8355 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8356 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8357 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8358 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8359 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8360 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8361 cannot be forced from the request.
8362
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008363 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008364 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8365 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8366
8367 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8368 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008369
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008370
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008371use-server <server> if <condition>
8372use-server <server> unless <condition>
8373 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8375 no | no | yes | yes
8376 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008377 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008378
8379 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8380
8381 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8382 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8383 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8384
8385 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8386 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8387 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8388 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8389 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8390 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8391 matches will assign the server.
8392
8393 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8394 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8395 with the next rules until one matches.
8396
8397 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8398 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8399 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8400 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8401
8402 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8403 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8404 stripped.
8405
8406 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8407 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8408 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8409 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8410
8411 Example :
8412 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8413 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8414 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8415 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8416 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8417 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8418 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8419 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8420 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8421
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008422 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008423
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008424
84255. Bind and Server options
8426--------------------------
8427
8428The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8429depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8430settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8431written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8432described in this section.
8433
8434
84355.1. Bind options
8436-----------------
8437
8438The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8439as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8440no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8441parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8442while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8443provided immediately after the setting name.
8444
8445The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8446
8447accept-proxy
8448 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02008449 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
8450 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008451 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8452 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8453 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8454 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8455 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8456 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8457 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008458 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8459 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008460
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008461alpn <protocols>
8462 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8463 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8464 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8465 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8466 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8467 initial NPN extension.
8468
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008469backlog <backlog>
8470 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8471 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8472
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008473ecdhe <named curve>
8474 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008475 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8476 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008477
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008478ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008479 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8480 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8481 client's certificate.
8482
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008483ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8484 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8485 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8486 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8487 error is ignored.
8488
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008489ciphers <ciphers>
8490 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8491 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008492 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008493 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8494 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8495
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008496crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008497 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8498 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8499 to verify client's certificate.
8500
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008501crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008502 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8503 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8504 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8505 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8506 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8507 file.
8508
8509 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8510 are loaded.
8511
8512 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008513 that directory will be loaded unless their name ends with '.issuer' or
8514 '.ocsp' (reserved extensions). This directive may be specified multiple times
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008515 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
8516 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
8517 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
8518 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
8519 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
8520 www.sub.example.org).
8521
8522 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8523 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8524 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8525 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
8526 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
8527
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008528 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008529
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008530 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8531 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008532 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008533 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8534 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8535 clients).
8536
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02008537 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
8538 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
8539 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
8540 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
8541 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
8542 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
8543 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
8544 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
8545 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
8546 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
8547 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
8548 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
8549 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
8550
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008551crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008552 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8553 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008554 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008555 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008556
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008557crt-list <file>
8558 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008559 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8560 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008561
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008562 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008563
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008564 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8565 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8566 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8567 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8568 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8569 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8570 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8571 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008572
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008573defer-accept
8574 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8575 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8576 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8577 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8578 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8579 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8580 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8581 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8582 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8583 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8584 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8585
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008586force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008587 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008588 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008589 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
8590 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008591
8592force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008593 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008594 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8595 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008596
8597force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008598 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008599 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8600 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008601
8602force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008603 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008604 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
8605 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008606
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008607gid <gid>
8608 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8609 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8610 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8611 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8612 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8613
8614group <group>
8615 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8616 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8617 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8618 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8619 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8620
8621id <id>
8622 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8623 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8624 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8625 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8626
8627interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008628 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8629 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8630 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8631 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8632 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8633 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8634 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008635
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008636level <level>
8637 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8638 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8639 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8640 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8641 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8642 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8643 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8644 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8645 counters).
8646 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8647 all counters).
8648
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008649maxconn <maxconn>
8650 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8651 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8652 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8653 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8654 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8655 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8656 eat all memory.
8657
8658mode <mode>
8659 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8660 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8661 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8662 UNIX sockets.
8663
8664mss <maxseg>
8665 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8666 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8667 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8668 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8669 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8670 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8671 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8672 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8673 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8674 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8675 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8676
8677name <name>
8678 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8679 page.
8680
8681nice <nice>
8682 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8683 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8684 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8685 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8686 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8687 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8688 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8689 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8690 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8691 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8692 one for an RDP socket.
8693
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008694no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008695 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008696 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008697 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008698 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
8699 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008700 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008701
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008702no-tls-tickets
8703 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8704 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8705 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008706 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
8707 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008708
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008709no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008710 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008711 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008712 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008713 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8714 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8715 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008716
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008717no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008718 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008719 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008720 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008721 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8722 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8723 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008724
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008725no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008726 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008727 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008728 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01008729 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
8730 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
8731 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008732
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008733npn <protocols>
8734 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8735 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8736 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8737 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008738 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8739 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008740
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008741process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8742 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8743 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8744 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8745 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8746 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8747 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8748 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008749 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8750 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8751 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8752 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8753 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
8754 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
8755 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008756
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008757ssl
8758 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008759 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008760 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8761 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8762 to deciphered contents.
8763
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008764strict-sni
8765 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8766 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8767 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8768 See the "crt" option for more information.
8769
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008770tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008771 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008772 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8773 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8774 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8775 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8776 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8777 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8778 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008779 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8780 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8781 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008782
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008783transparent
8784 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8785 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8786 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8787 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8788 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8789 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8790 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8791 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8792 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8793 so check for support with your vendor.
8794
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008795v4v6
8796 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8797 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8798 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8799 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008800 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008801
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008802v6only
8803 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8804 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8805 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008806 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8807 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008808
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008809uid <uid>
8810 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8811 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8812 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8813 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8814 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8815
8816user <user>
8817 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8818 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8819 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8820 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8821 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8822
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008823verify [none|optional|required]
8824 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8825 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8826 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8827 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8828 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008829 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8830 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8831 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8832 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008833
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020088345.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008835------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008836
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008837The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8838which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8839arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8840settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8841after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8842Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8843address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008844
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008845 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008846 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008847
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008848The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008849
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008850addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008851 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8852 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8853 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8854 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8855 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008856
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008857 Supported in default-server: No
8858
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008859agent-check
8860 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008861 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
8862 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
8863 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
8864 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008865
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008866 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008867 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +02008868 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
8869 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
8870 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008871
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008872 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8873 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008874
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008875 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8876 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
8877 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008878
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008879 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8880 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
8881 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008882
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008883 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
8884 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
8885 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
8886 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
8887 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
8888 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
8889 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008890
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008891 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
8892 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008893
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008894 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
8895 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
8896 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
8897 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
8898 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
8899 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
8900 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
8901 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
8902 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008903
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008904 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8905 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008906 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
8907 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
8908 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
8909 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008910
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008911 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
8912 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008913
8914 Supported in default-server: No
8915
8916agent-inter <delay>
8917 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8918 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8919
8920 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8921 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8922 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8923 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8924 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8925 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8926 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8927 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8928 of backends use the same servers.
8929
8930 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8931
8932 Supported in default-server: Yes
8933
8934agent-port <port>
8935 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8936
8937 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8938
8939 Supported in default-server: Yes
8940
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008941backup
8942 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8943 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8944 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8945 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8946 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8947 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008948
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008949 Supported in default-server: No
8950
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008951ca-file <cafile>
8952 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8953 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8954 server's certificate.
8955
8956 Supported in default-server: No
8957
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008958check
8959 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008960 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8961 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8962 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8963 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8964 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8965 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8966 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008967 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8968 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8969 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008970
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008971 Supported in default-server: No
8972
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008973check-send-proxy
8974 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8975 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8976 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8977 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8978 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8979 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8980 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8981
8982 Supported in default-server: No
8983
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008984check-ssl
8985 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8986 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8987 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8988 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008989 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008990 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8991 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8992 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8993 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8994
8995 Supported in default-server: No
8996
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008997ciphers <ciphers>
8998 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008999 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009000 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
9001 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
9002 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
9003 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
9004 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
9005 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
9006
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009007 Supported in default-server: No
9008
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009009cookie <value>
9010 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
9011 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
9012 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
9013 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
9014 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
9015 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
9016 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
9017
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009018 Supported in default-server: No
9019
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009020crl-file <crlfile>
9021 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9022 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9023 to verify server's certificate.
9024
9025 Supported in default-server: No
9026
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02009027crt <cert>
9028 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9029 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
9030 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
9031 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
9032 certificate request.
9033
9034 Supported in default-server: No
9035
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02009036disabled
9037 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
9038 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
9039 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
9040 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
9041 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
9042
9043 Supported in default-server: No
9044
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009045error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009046 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
9047 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
9048 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009049
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009050 Supported in default-server: Yes
9051
9052 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009053
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009054fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009055 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
9056 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
9057 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
9058
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009059 Supported in default-server: Yes
9060
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009061force-sslv3
9062 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
9063 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009064 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9065 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009066
9067 Supported in default-server: No
9068
9069force-tlsv10
9070 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009071 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9072 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009073
9074 Supported in default-server: No
9075
9076force-tlsv11
9077 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009078 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9079 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009080
9081 Supported in default-server: No
9082
9083force-tlsv12
9084 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009085 the server. This option is also available on global statement
9086 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009087
9088 Supported in default-server: No
9089
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009090id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02009091 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
9092 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
9093 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009094
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009095 Supported in default-server: No
9096
9097inter <delay>
9098fastinter <delay>
9099downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009100 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
9101 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
9102 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
9103 between checks depending on the server state :
9104
9105 Server state | Interval used
9106 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9107 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
9108 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9109 Transitionally UP (going down), |
9110 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9111 or yet unchecked. |
9112 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
9113 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
9114 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009115
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009116 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
9117 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
9118 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
9119 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09009120 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
9121 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
9122 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
9123 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
9124 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009125
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009126 Supported in default-server: Yes
9127
9128maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009129 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
9130 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
9131 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
9132 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
9133 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
9134 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
9135 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
9136 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
9137
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009138 Supported in default-server: Yes
9139
9140maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009141 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
9142 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
9143 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
9144 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
9145 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
9146 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
9147 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
9148
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009149 Supported in default-server: Yes
9150
9151minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009152 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
9153 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
9154 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
9155 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
9156 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
9157 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009158 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009159 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009160
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009161 Supported in default-server: Yes
9162
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009163no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009164 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
9165 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009166 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009167
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009168 Supported in default-server: No
9169
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009170no-tls-tickets
9171 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9172 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
9173 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009174 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
9175 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02009176
9177 Supported in default-server: No
9178
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009179no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009180 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009181 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9182 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009183 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9184 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9185 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009186
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009187 Supported in default-server: No
9188
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009189no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009190 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009191 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9192 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009193 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9194 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9195 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02009196
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009197 Supported in default-server: No
9198
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02009199no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02009200 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009201 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
9202 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009203 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
9204 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
9205 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009206
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009207 Supported in default-server: No
9208
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09009209non-stick
9210 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
9211 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
9212 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
9213
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009214 Supported in default-server: No
9215
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009216observe <mode>
9217 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
9218 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
9219 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
9220 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
9221 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
9222 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01009223 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009224
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009225 Supported in default-server: No
9226
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009227 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
9228
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009229on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009230 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
9231 Currently, four modes are available:
9232 - fastinter: force fastinter
9233 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
9234 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
9235 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
9236 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
9237
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009238 Supported in default-server: Yes
9239
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01009240 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
9241
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009242on-marked-down <action>
9243 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
9244 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009245 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
9246 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
9247 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
9248 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
9249 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
9250 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
9251 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
9252 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09009253
9254 Actions are disabled by default
9255
9256 Supported in default-server: Yes
9257
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07009258on-marked-up <action>
9259 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
9260 Currently one action is available:
9261 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
9262 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
9263 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
9264 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
9265 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
9266 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
9267 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
9268 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
9269
9270 Actions are disabled by default
9271
9272 Supported in default-server: Yes
9273
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009274port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009275 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
9276 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
9277 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
9278 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
9279 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
9280 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
9281
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009282 Supported in default-server: Yes
9283
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009284redir <prefix>
9285 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
9286 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
9287 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
9288 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
9289 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
9290 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
9291 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
9292 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009293 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009294 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
9295 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
9296 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
9297 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
9298 loop between the client and HAProxy!
9299
9300 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
9301
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009302 Supported in default-server: No
9303
9304rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009305 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
9306 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
9307 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
9308
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009309 Supported in default-server: Yes
9310
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009311send-proxy
9312 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
9313 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
9314 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
9315 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
9316 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
9317 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
9318 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
9319 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
9320 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02009321 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
9322 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
9323 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
9324 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
9325 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01009326
9327 Supported in default-server: No
9328
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04009329send-proxy-v2
9330 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
9331 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9332 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9333 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9334 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
9335 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
9336 option of the "bind" keyword.
9337
9338 Supported in default-server: No
9339
9340send-proxy-v2-ssl
9341 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9342 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9343 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9344 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9345 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9346 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
9347 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
9348 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9349
9350 Supported in default-server: No
9351
9352send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
9353 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
9354 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
9355 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
9356 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
9357 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
9358 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
9359 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
9360 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
9361 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
9362
9363 Supported in default-server: No
9364
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009365slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009366 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
9367 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
9368 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
9369 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
9370 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
9371 parameters :
9372
9373 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
9374 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
9375
9376 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
9377 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
9378 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
9379 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
9380
9381 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
9382 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
9383 seen as failed.
9384
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009385 Supported in default-server: Yes
9386
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009387source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009388source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009389source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009390 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9391 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9392 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9393 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9394
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009395 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9396 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9397 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9398 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9399 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9400 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9401 server.
9402
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009403 Supported in default-server: No
9404
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009405ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009406 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9407 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9408 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9409 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9410 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9411 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009412 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009413
9414 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009415
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009416track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009417 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9418 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9419 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9420 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009421 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9422
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009423 Supported in default-server: No
9424
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009425verify [none|required]
9426 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009427 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9428 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9429 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9430 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009431 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9432 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9433 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009434
9435 Supported in default-server: No
9436
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009437verifyhost <hostname>
9438 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9439 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9440 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9441 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9442 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9443 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9444
9445 Supported in default-server: No
9446
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009447weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009448 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9449 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9450 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009451 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9452 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9453 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9454 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9455 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9456 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009457
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009458 Supported in default-server: Yes
9459
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009460
94616. HTTP header manipulation
9462---------------------------
9463
9464In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9465response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9466request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9467which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009468against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009469
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009470If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9471to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9472but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9473HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9474stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9475because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9476a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9477still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009478
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009479This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9480in section 4.2 :
9481
9482 - reqadd <string>
9483 - reqallow <search>
9484 - reqiallow <search>
9485 - reqdel <search>
9486 - reqidel <search>
9487 - reqdeny <search>
9488 - reqideny <search>
9489 - reqpass <search>
9490 - reqipass <search>
9491 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9492 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9493 - reqtarpit <search>
9494 - reqitarpit <search>
9495 - rspadd <string>
9496 - rspdel <search>
9497 - rspidel <search>
9498 - rspdeny <search>
9499 - rspideny <search>
9500 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9501 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9502
9503With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9504is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9505parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9506prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9507Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9508
9509 \t for a tab
9510 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9511 \n for a new line (LF)
9512 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9513 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9514 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9515 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9516 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9517
9518The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9519portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9520above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9521regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
95229 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9523is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9524
9525The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9526after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9527
9528Notes related to these keywords :
9529---------------------------------
9530 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9531 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9532 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9533
9534 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9535 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9536 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9537
9538 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9539 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9540 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9541 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9542 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9543
9544 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9545 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9546 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9547 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9548 useless headers before adding new ones.
9549
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009550 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009551 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9552
9553 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9554 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9555 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9556
9557 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9558 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009559 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009560
9561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020095627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9563----------------------------------
9564
9565Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9566client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9567The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9568these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9569but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9570data called patterns.
9571
9572
95737.1. ACL basics
9574---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009575
9576The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9577content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9578from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9579simple :
9580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009581 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009582 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009583 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9584 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009586The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9587adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009588
9589In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009591 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009592
9593This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9594Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9595and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009596an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9597conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9598as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9599are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009600
9601ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9602'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9603which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9604
9605There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9606performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009608The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9609specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9610this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009611methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9612ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009613
9614Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9615 - boolean
9616 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9617 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9618 - string
9619 - data block
9620
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009621Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9622converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9623would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9624The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9625which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9626
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009627Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9628keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9629fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
9630which are summarized in the table below :
9631
9632 +---------------------+-----------------+
9633 | Sample or converter | Default |
9634 | output type | matching method |
9635 +---------------------+-----------------+
9636 | boolean | bool |
9637 +---------------------+-----------------+
9638 | integer | int |
9639 +---------------------+-----------------+
9640 | ip | ip |
9641 +---------------------+-----------------+
9642 | string | str |
9643 +---------------------+-----------------+
9644 | binary | none, use "-m" |
9645 +---------------------+-----------------+
9646
9647Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
9648matching method, see below.
9649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009650The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9651 - boolean
9652 - integer or integer range
9653 - IP address / network
9654 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9655 - regular expression
9656 - hex block
9657
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009658The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9659
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009660 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9661 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009662 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009663 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009664 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009665 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009666 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009668The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9669read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9670if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9671lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9672will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9673beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9674a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9675lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9676exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9677
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009678The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9679parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9680ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9681a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9682check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9683
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009684The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9685socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9686file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009688Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9689loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9690
9691 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9692
9693In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9694the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9695case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9696as well.
9697
9698The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9699sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9700do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9701methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9702is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9703obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9704followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9705default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9706that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9707string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9708
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009709The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9710By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9711string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9712resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9713server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9714waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9715flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9716function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009718There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9719sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9720be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009721
9722 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9723 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009724 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9725 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9726 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9727 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009728
9729 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9730 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009731 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009732
9733 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009734 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009735
9736 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009737 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009738
9739 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9740 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9741
9742 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9743 binary or string samples.
9744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009745 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9746 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009748 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9749 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9750 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009752 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9753 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009755 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9756 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009758 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9759 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009761 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9762 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009763 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009765 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9766 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9767 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009768
9769For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9770request, it is possible to do :
9771
9772 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9773
9774In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9775buffer, one would use the following acl :
9776
9777 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9778
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009779On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9780possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9781
9782 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009784All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9785criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9786method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9787to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9788criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9789the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009791If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009792the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9793For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009795 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9796 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9797 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9798 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009799
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009800
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009801The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
9802types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9803combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
9804brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
9805default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009807 +-------------------------------------------------+
9808 | Input sample type |
9809 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009810 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009811 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9812 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9813 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009814 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009815 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009816 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009817 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009818 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009819 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009820 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009821 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009822 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009823 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009824 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009825 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009826 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009827 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009828 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009829 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009830 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009831 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009832 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009833 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009834 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009835 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9836 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9837 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009838
9839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098407.1.1. Matching booleans
9841------------------------
9842
9843In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9844Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9845When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9846that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9847
9848Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9849return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9850"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9851
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098537.1.2. Matching integers
9854------------------------
9855
9856Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9857enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9858to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9859
9860Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9861matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9862lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009863
9864For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9865unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9866representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9867
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009868As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9869two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9870instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9871ranges and operators.
9872
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009873For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009874operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9875Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9876of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009877
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009878Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009879
9880 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9881 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9882 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9883 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9884 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9885
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009886For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009887
9888 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9889
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009890This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9891
9892 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9893
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020098957.1.3. Matching strings
9896-----------------------
9897
9898String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9899different forms :
9900
9901 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9902 patterns ;
9903
9904 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9905 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9906
9907 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9908 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9909
9910 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9911 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9912
9913 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9914 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9915 matches.
9916
9917 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9918 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9919 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009920
9921String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9922exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9923characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9924string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9925to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009926before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009927
9928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020099297.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9930---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009931
9932Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9933they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9934possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9935passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9936the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009937the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9938match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009939
9940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020099417.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9942-------------------------------------
9943
9944It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9945not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9946a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9947to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9948digits may be used upper or lower case.
9949
9950Example :
9951 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9952 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9953
9954
99557.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9956---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009957
9958IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9959netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9960within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009961host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009962difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9963at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9964does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9965parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009966
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009967IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9968Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9969trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9970IPv6 patterns.
9971
9972HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9973following situations :
9974 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9975 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9976 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9977 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9978 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9979 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9980 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9981 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9982 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9983 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009985
99867.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9987----------------------------------
9988
9989Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9990combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9991
9992 - AND (implicit)
9993 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9994 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009996A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009998 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010000Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
10001indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020010002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010003For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
10004"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
10005requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
10006is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
10007
10008 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10009 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
10010 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
10011 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
10012
10013To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
10014and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
10015
10016 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
10017 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
10018 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
10019 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
10020
10021 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
10022 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
10023 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
10024 use_backend www if host_www
10025
10026It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
10027expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
10028be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
10029the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
10030
10031 The following rule :
10032
10033 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
10034 block if METH_POST missing_cl
10035
10036 Can also be written that way :
10037
10038 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
10039
10040It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
10041to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
10042simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
10043sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
10044good use is the following :
10045
10046 With named ACLs :
10047
10048 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
10049 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
10050 monitor fail if site_dead
10051
10052 With anonymous ACLs :
10053
10054 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
10055
10056See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
10057
10058
100597.3. Fetching samples
10060---------------------
10061
10062Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
10063against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
10064sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
10065ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
10066of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
10067available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
10068
10069This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
10070Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
10071compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
10072deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
10073
10074The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
10075matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
10076method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
10077indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
10078
10079As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
10080when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
10081mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
10082the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
10083ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
10084
10085Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
10086multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
10087when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
10088incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
10089are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
10090is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
10091all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
10092
10093Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
10094 - name
10095 - name(arg1)
10096 - name(arg1,arg2)
10097
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010098
100997.3.1. Converters
10100-----------------
10101
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010010102Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
10103of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
10104is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
10105was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
10106has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
10107unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
10108
10109These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
10110sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
10111the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
10112support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010114The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010115
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020010116base64
10117 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
10118 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
10119 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
10120
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010010121bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
10122 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
10123 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
10124 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
10125
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010126djb2([<avalanche>])
10127 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
10128 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10129 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10130 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10131 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10132 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10133 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
10134 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type"
10135 directive.
10136
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010010137field(<index>,<delimiters>)
10138 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
10139 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
10140 list of chars.
10141
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010142hex
10143 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
10144 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
10145 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
10146 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010010147
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010148http_date([<offset>])
10149 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10150 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
10151 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
10152 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
10153 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
10154 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010155
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010156in_table(<table>)
10157 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10158 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
10159 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
10160 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
10161 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
10162
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010163ipmask(<mask>)
10164 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
10165 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
10166 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
10167 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
10168
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020010169json([<input-code>])
10170 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
10171 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
10172 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8"" or
10173 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
10174 of errors:
10175 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
10176 bytes, ...)
10177 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
10178 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
10179
10180 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
10181 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
10182 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
10183 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
10184 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
10185 are :
10186 - "ascii" : never fails ;
10187 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
10188 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
10189 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
10190 error ;
10191 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
10192 characters corresponding to the other errors.
10193
10194 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
10195 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
10196
10197 Example:
10198 capture request header user-agent len 150
10199 capture request header Host len 15
10200 log-format {"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json]"}
10201
10202 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
10203 GET / HTTP/1.0
10204 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
10205
10206 Output log:
10207 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
10208
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010209language(<value>[,<default>])
10210 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
10211 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
10212 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
10213 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
10214 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
10215 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
10216 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
10217 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
10218 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
10219 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
10220 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
10221 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010222
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010223 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010224
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010225 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
10226 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010227
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010228 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
10229 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
10230 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
10231 use_backend spanish if es
10232 use_backend french if fr
10233 use_backend english if en
10234 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020010235
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010236lower
10237 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
10238 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10239 type. The result is of type string.
10240
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010241ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
10242 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10243 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
10244 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10245 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10246 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10247 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
10248
10249 Example :
10250
10251 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
10252 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10253 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10254
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010255map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10256map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10257map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
10258 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
10259 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
10260 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
10261 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
10262 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
10263 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
10264 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
10265 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010266
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010267 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
10268 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
10269 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010270
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010271 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
10272 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010273
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010274 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
10275 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10276 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
10277 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020010278 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
10279 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010280 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
10281 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10282 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
10283 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10284 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
10285 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10286 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
10287 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10288 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
10289 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10290 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
10291 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
10292 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
10293 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010294
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010295 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
10296 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
10297 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
10298 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
10299 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010300
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020010301 Example :
10302
10303 # this is a comment and is ignored
10304 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
10305 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
10306 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
10307 | | | `---------- value
10308 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
10309 | `---------------------------- key
10310 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
10311
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010312sdbm([<avalanche>])
10313 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
10314 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10315 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10316 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10317 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10318 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10319 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
10320 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "djb2", "wt6" and the "hash-type"
10321 directive.
10322
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020010323table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
10324 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10325 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10326 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
10327 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10328 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10329 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
10330
10331
10332table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
10333 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10334 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10335 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
10336 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
10337 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
10338 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
10339
10340table_conn_cnt(<table>)
10341 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10342 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10343 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10344 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
10345 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10346
10347table_conn_cur(<table>)
10348 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10349 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10350 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10351 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
10352 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
10353
10354table_conn_rate(<table>)
10355 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10356 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10357 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
10358 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10359 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
10360
10361table_gpc0(<table>)
10362 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10363 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10364 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
10365 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
10366 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
10367
10368table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
10369 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10370 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10371 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
10372 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
10373 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
10374 sample fetch keyword.
10375
10376table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
10377 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10378 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10379 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10380 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
10381 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10382
10383table_http_err_rate(<table>)
10384 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10385 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10386 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
10387 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
10388 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
10389 keyword.
10390
10391table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
10392 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10393 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10394 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
10395 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
10396 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
10397
10398table_http_req_rate(<table>)
10399 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10400 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10401 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
10402 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
10403 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
10404 keyword.
10405
10406table_kbytes_in(<table>)
10407 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10408 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10409 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
10410 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10411 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
10412 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
10413 keyword.
10414
10415table_kbytes_out(<table>)
10416 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10417 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10418 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
10419 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
10420 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
10421 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
10422 keyword.
10423
10424table_server_id(<table>)
10425 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10426 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10427 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
10428 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
10429 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
10430 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
10431
10432table_sess_cnt(<table>)
10433 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10434 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10435 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
10436 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
10437 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
10438 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
10439 keyword.
10440
10441table_sess_rate(<table>)
10442 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10443 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10444 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
10445 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
10446 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
10447 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
10448 keyword.
10449
10450table_trackers(<table>)
10451 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
10452 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
10453 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
10454 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
10455 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
10456 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
10457 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
10458 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
10459 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
10460 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
10461
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020010462upper
10463 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
10464 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
10465 type. The result is of type string.
10466
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020010467utime(<format>[,<offset>])
10468 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
10469 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
10470 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
10471 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
10472 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
10473 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
10474
10475 Example :
10476
10477 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
10478 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
10479 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
10480
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010010481word(<index>,<delimiters>)
10482 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
10483 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
10484
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020010485wt6([<avalanche>])
10486 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
10487 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
10488 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
10489 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
10490 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
10491 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
10492 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
10493 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "djb2", "sdbm", and the "hash-type"
10494 directive.
10495
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010496
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200104977.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010498--------------------------------------------
10499
10500A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
10501not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
10502"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
10503The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
10504
10505always_false : boolean
10506 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10507 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10508
10509always_true : boolean
10510 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
10511 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
10512
10513avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010514 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010515 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
10516 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
10517 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
10518 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
10519 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
10520 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
10521 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
10522 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
10523 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
10524 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
10525 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
10526 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
10527 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010010528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010529be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010530 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
10531 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
10532 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
10533 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
10534 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010536be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
10537 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10538 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10539 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
10540 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
10541 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
10542 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010543
10544 Example :
10545 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
10546 backend dynamic
10547 mode http
10548 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
10549 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010551connslots([<backend>]) : integer
10552 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010553 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010554 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
10555 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050010556
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010557 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010558 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010559 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
10560
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010561 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
10562 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010563
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010564 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010565 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010566 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010567 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
10568 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010569 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010570 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010571
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010572 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
10573 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010574 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010575 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080010576
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010577date([<offset>]) : integer
10578 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
10579 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
10580 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
10581 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020010582 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
10583
10584 Example :
10585
10586 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
10587 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020010588
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020010589env(<name>) : string
10590 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
10591 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
10592 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
10593 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
10594 certain way.
10595
10596 Examples :
10597 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
10598 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
10599
10600 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
10601 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
10602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010603fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
10604 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010605 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
10606 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010607 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
10608 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
10609 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
10610 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
10611 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020010612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010613fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
10614 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10615 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
10616 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
10617 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
10618 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
10619 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
10620 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
10621 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010622
10623 Example :
10624 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
10625 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
10626 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
10627 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
10628 frontend mail
10629 bind :25
10630 mode tcp
10631 maxconn 100
10632 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
10633 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
10634 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
10635 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010636
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010637nbproc : integer
10638 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
10639 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
10640 and debugging purposes.
10641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010642nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
10643 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
10644 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
10645 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010646 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
10647 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
10648 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010649
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010650proc : integer
10651 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
10652 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
10653 debugging purposes.
10654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010655queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010656 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
10657 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
10658 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010659 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
10660 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
10661 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
10662 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
10663 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
10664
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010010665rand([<range>]) : integer
10666 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
10667 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
10668 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
10669 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
10670 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
10671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010672srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10673 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10674 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
10675 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
10676 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
10677 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
10678 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
10679 methods.
10680
10681srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
10682 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
10683 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
10684 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
10685 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
10686 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
10687 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
10688 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
10689
10690srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10691 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10692 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010693 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010694 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
10695 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
10696 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
10697 overloading servers).
10698
10699 Example :
10700 # Redirect to a separate back
10701 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
10702 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
10703 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
10704
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010010705stopping : boolean
10706 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
10707 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
10708 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
10709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010710table_avl([<table>]) : integer
10711 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
10712 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
10713
10714table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10715 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
10716 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
10717 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
10718
10719
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200107207.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010721----------------------------------
10722
10723The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
10724closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
10725methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
10726sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
10727TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010728the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
10729counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
10730"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010731argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
10732the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
10733this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010734
10735be_id : integer
10736 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
10737 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
10738
10739dst : ip
10740 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
10741 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
10742 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
10743 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
10744 RFC 4291.
10745
10746dst_conn : integer
10747 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10748 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
10749 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
10750 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
10751 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
10752 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
10753 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
10754 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010756dst_port : integer
10757 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
10758 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
10759 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
10760 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
10761 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
10762 an HTTP header.
10763
10764fe_id : integer
10765 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
10766 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
10767 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
10768
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010769sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010770sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10771sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10772sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010773 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
10774 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10775 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
10776
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010777sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010778sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10779sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10780sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010781 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
10782 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10783 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
10784
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010785sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010786sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10787sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10788sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010789 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
10790 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010791 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
10792 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
10793 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010794
10795 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10796 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010797 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10798 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
10799 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010800 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10801 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10802
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010803sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010804sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10805sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10806sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010807 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
10808 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
10809
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010810sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010811sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10812sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10813sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010814 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10815 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
10816 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
10817
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010818sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010819sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10820sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10821sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010822 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
10823 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
10824 See also src_conn_rate.
10825
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010826sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010827sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10828sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10829sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010830 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010831 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010832
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010833sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010834sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10835sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10836sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010837 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10838 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
10839 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010840 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10841 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10842 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010843
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010844sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010845sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10846sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10847sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010848 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
10849 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
10850 See also src_http_err_cnt.
10851
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010852sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010853sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10854sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10855sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010856 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
10857 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10858 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
10859 src_http_err_rate.
10860
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010861sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010862sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10863sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10864sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010865 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10866 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10867 src_http_req_cnt.
10868
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010869sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010870sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10871sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10872sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010873 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10874 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
10875 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10876 src_http_req_rate.
10877
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010878sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010879sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10880sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10881sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010882 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010883 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
10884 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
10885 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
10886 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010887
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010888 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10889 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010890 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10891
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010892sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010893sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10894sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10895sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010896 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
10897 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10898 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010899
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010900sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010901sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10902sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10903sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020010904 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
10905 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
10906 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010907
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010908sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010909sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10910sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10911sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010912 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
10913 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
10914 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
10915 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010916 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010917 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
10918
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010919sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010920sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10921sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10922sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010923 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
10924 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10925 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
10926 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
10927 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010928 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010929
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010930sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010931sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10932sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10933sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020010934 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
10935 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
10936 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
10937
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010938sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010939sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10940sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10941sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010942 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10943 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010944 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010945 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
10946 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010947 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
10948 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
10949 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010951so_id : integer
10952 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
10953 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
10954 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010956src : ip
10957 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
10958 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
10959 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
10960 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
10961 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
10962 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
10963 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010964
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010965 Example:
10966 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
10967 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
10968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010969src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10970 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
10971 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
10972 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010973 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010975src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10976 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
10977 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010978 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010979 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010981src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10982 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10983 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10984 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
10985 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
10986 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
10987 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010988
10989 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10990 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
10991 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
10992 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010993 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010994 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10995 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010997src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010998 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010999 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011000 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011001 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011003src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011004 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011005 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
11006 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011007 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011009src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
11010 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
11011 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11012 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011013 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011015src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011016 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011017 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011018 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011019 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011021src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011022 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011023 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011024 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
11025 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011026 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
11027 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
11028 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011030src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11031 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
11032 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011033 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011034 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011035 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011037src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
11038 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
11039 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11040 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
11041 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011042 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011044src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11045 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
11046 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
11047 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011048 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011050src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
11051 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
11052 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
11053 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011054 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011055 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011057src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
11058 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
11059 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11060 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011061 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011062 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
11063 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011064
11065 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010011066 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011067 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011069src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011070 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
11071 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
11072 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
11073 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
11074 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011076src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020011077 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
11078 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11079 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
11080 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
11081 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011083src_port : integer
11084 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
11085 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
11086 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
11087 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010011088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011089src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11090 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011091 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
11092 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
11093 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011094 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011096src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
11097 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
11098 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
11099 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
11100 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020011101 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011103src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
11104 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
11105 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
11106 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
11107 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
11108 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
11109 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
11110 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
11111 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011112
11113 Example :
11114 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
11115 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
11116 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
11117 listen ssh
11118 bind :22
11119 mode tcp
11120 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011121 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011122 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020011123 server local 127.0.0.1:22
11124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011125srv_id : integer
11126 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
11127 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
11128 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020011129
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010011130
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200111317.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011132----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020011133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011134The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
11135closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
11136when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
11137usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011138future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011139
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011140ssl_bc : boolean
11141 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11142 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
11143 other a server with the "ssl" option.
11144
11145ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
11146 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
11147 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11148
11149ssl_bc_cipher : string
11150 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
11151 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11152
11153ssl_bc_protocol : string
11154 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
11155 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11156
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011157ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011158 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011159 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11160 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020011161
11162ssl_bc_session_id : binary
11163 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
11164 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
11165 if session was reused or not.
11166
11167ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
11168 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
11169 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011171ssl_c_ca_err : integer
11172 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11173 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
11174 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
11175 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
11176 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020011177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011178ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
11179 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11180 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
11181 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
11182 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011183
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011184ssl_c_der : binary
11185 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
11186 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11187 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011189ssl_c_err : integer
11190 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11191 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
11192 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
11193 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
11194 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011196ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11197 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11198 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11199 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11200 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11201 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11202 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11203 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11204 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011206ssl_c_key_alg : string
11207 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11208 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11209 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011211ssl_c_notafter : string
11212 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
11213 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11214 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011216ssl_c_notbefore : string
11217 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
11218 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11219 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011221ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11222 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11223 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11224 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11225 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11226 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11227 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11228 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11229 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010011230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011231ssl_c_serial : binary
11232 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
11233 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11234 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011236ssl_c_sha1 : binary
11237 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
11238 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
11239 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020011240 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
11241 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
11242
11243 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011245ssl_c_sig_alg : string
11246 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11247 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11248 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011250ssl_c_used : boolean
11251 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
11252 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011254ssl_c_verify : integer
11255 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
11256 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
11257 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
11258 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011260ssl_c_version : integer
11261 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
11262 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011263
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010011264ssl_f_der : binary
11265 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
11266 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11267 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
11268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011269ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11270 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11271 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
11272 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11273 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011274 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011275 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11276 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11277 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011279ssl_f_key_alg : string
11280 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
11281 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
11282 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011283
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011284ssl_f_notafter : string
11285 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11286 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11287 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011289ssl_f_notbefore : string
11290 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
11291 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
11292 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011294ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
11295 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
11296 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
11297 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
11298 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
11299 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
11300 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
11301 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
11302 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020011303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011304ssl_f_serial : binary
11305 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11306 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
11307 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020011308
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020011309ssl_f_sha1 : binary
11310 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
11311 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
11312 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
11313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011314ssl_f_sig_alg : string
11315 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
11316 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
11317 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020011318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011319ssl_f_version : integer
11320 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
11321 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11322
11323ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011324 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
11325 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
11326 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
11327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011328 Example :
11329 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
11330 listen http-https
11331 bind :80
11332 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
11333 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
11334
11335ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
11336 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
11337 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
11338
11339ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011340 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011341 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
11342 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
11343 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
11344 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
11345 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
11346 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
11347 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
11348 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
11349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011350ssl_fc_cipher : string
11351 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
11352 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011354ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011355 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
11356 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010011357 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
11358 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
11359 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
11360 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020011361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011362ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
11363 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020011364 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
11365 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
11366 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11367 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011369ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011370 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011371 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
11372 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
11373 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
11374 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
11375 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
11376 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
11377 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020011378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011379ssl_fc_protocol : string
11380 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
11381 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011382
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011383ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011384 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020011385 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
11386 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040011387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011388ssl_fc_session_id : binary
11389 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
11390 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
11391 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
11392 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020011393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011394ssl_fc_sni : string
11395 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
11396 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
11397 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
11398 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
11399 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
11400
11401 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
11402 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
11403 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020011404 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
11405 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011407 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011408 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
11409 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020011410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011411ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
11412 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
11413 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011414
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011415
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200114167.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011417------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020011418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011419Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
11420sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
11421only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
11422For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
11423be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
11424can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
11425sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
11426for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
11427content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011429payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
11430 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
11431 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
11432 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011434payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
11435 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
11436 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
11437 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011439req.len : integer
11440req_len : integer (deprecated)
11441 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11442 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11443 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11444 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11445 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11446 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11447 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
11448 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011450req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11451 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011452 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11453 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11454 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11455 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011457 ACL alternatives :
11458 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011460req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11461 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11462 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11463 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
11464 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011466 ACL alternatives :
11467 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011469 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011471req.proto_http : boolean
11472req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
11473 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
11474 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
11475 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
11476 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
11477 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
11478 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
11479 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011481 Example:
11482 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11483 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11484 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011485 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020011486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011487req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
11488rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11489 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
11490 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
11491 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
11492 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
11493 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
11494 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
11495 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011497 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
11498 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
11499 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
11500 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
11501 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
11502 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011504 ACL derivatives :
11505 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011507 Example :
11508 listen tse-farm
11509 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
11510 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11511 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11512 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11513 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11514 persist rdp-cookie
11515 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
11516 # This is only useful makes sense if
11517 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
11518 stick-table type string size 204800
11519 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
11520 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11521 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011523 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
11524 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011526req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
11527rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
11528 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
11529 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
11530 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
11531 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011533 ACL derivatives :
11534 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011536req.ssl_hello_type : integer
11537req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11538 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11539 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
11540 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11541 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11542 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
11543 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11544 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011546req.ssl_sni : string
11547req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
11548 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
11549 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
11550 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
11551 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11552 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11553 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
11554 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
11555 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
11556 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
11557 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
11558 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
11559 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011561 ACL derivatives :
11562 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011564 Examples :
11565 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
11566 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11567 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
11568 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
11569 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020011570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011571res.ssl_hello_type : integer
11572rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
11573 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
11574 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
11575 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
11576 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
11577 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
11578 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
11579 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020011580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011581req.ssl_ver : integer
11582req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
11583 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
11584 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
11585 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
11586 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
11587 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
11588 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
11589 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
11590 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
11591 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011593 ACL derivatives :
11594 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011595
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020011596res.len : integer
11597 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
11598 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
11599 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
11600 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
11601 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
11602 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
11603 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
11604 content inspection.
11605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011606res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
11607 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020011608 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
11609 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
11610 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
11611 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011613res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
11614 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
11615 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
11616 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
11617 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011619 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011621wait_end : boolean
11622 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
11623 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
11624 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
11625 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
11626 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
11627 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
11628 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
11629 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011631 Examples :
11632 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
11633 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
11634 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011636 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
11637 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
11638 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
11639 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
11640 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
11641 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
11642 tcp-request content reject
11643
11644
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200116457.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011646--------------------------------------
11647
11648It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
11649This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
11650data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
11651its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
11652HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
11653content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
11654to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
11655more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
11656response are indexed.
11657
11658base : string
11659 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
11660 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
11661 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
11662 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
11663 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
11664 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
11665 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
11666 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
11667
11668 ACL derivatives :
11669 base : exact string match
11670 base_beg : prefix match
11671 base_dir : subdir match
11672 base_dom : domain match
11673 base_end : suffix match
11674 base_len : length match
11675 base_reg : regex match
11676 base_sub : substring match
11677
11678base32 : integer
11679 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
11680 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
11681 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011682 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
11683 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
11684 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011685
11686base32+src : binary
11687 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
11688 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
11689 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
11690 per-URL counters.
11691
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011692capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
11693 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
11694 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11695 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
11696
11697capture.req.method : string
11698 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
11699 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
11700 because it's allocated.
11701
11702capture.req.uri : string
11703 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
11704 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
11705 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
11706 allocated.
11707
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011708capture.req.ver : string
11709 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11710 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
11711 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
11712
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011713capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
11714 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
11715 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11716 The first entry is an index of 0.
11717 See also: "capture response header"
11718
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011719capture.res.ver : string
11720 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11721 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
11722 persistent flag.
11723
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011724req.cook([<name>]) : string
11725cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11726 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11727 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11728 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
11729 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
11730 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
11731 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
11732 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
11733 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
11734
11735 ACL derivatives :
11736 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
11737 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
11738 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
11739 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
11740 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
11741 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
11742 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
11743 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011745req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11746cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11747 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11748 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011750req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11751cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11752 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11753 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
11754 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
11755 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011757cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11758 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11759 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
11760 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
11761 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
11762 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
11763 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
11764 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
11765 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
11766 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
11767 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011769hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11770 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
11771 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
11772 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
11773 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011774 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011776req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
11777 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11778 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11779 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11780 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11781 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11782 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
11783 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
11784 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011786req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11787 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11788 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11789 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11790 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011792req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11793 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11794 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11795 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11796 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11797 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11798 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
11799 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
11800 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
11801 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
11802 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
11803 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011805 ACL derivatives :
11806 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11807 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11808 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11809 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11810 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11811 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11812 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11813 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11814
11815req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11816hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
11817 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11818 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
11819 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
11820 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
11821 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
11822 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
11823 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
11824 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
11825 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
11826
11827req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11828hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11829 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
11830 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
11831 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
11832 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11833 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11834 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11835 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
11836 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
11837
11838req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11839hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11840 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
11841 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
11842 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
11843 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11844 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11845 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11846 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
11847
11848http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
11849 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
11850 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
11851 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11852 basic auth is supported.
11853
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011854http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
11855 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
11856 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
11857 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
11858 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011859 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11860 basic auth is supported.
11861
11862 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011863 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
11864 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
11865 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
11866 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011867
11868http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011869 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
11870 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011871 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
11872 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011874method : integer + string
11875 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
11876 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
11877 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
11878 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
11879 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
11880 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
11881 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011883 ACL derivatives :
11884 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011886 Example :
11887 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
11888 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
11889 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011891path : string
11892 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
11893 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
11894 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
11895 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
11896 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
11897 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
11898 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011900 ACL derivatives :
11901 path : exact string match
11902 path_beg : prefix match
11903 path_dir : subdir match
11904 path_dom : domain match
11905 path_end : suffix match
11906 path_len : length match
11907 path_reg : regex match
11908 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011910req.ver : string
11911req_ver : string (deprecated)
11912 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
11913 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
11914 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011915
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011916 ACL derivatives :
11917 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011919res.comp : boolean
11920 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
11921 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
11922 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011924res.comp_algo : string
11925 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
11926 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
11927 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011929res.cook([<name>]) : string
11930scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11931 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11932 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11933 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011935 ACL derivatives :
11936 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011938res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11939scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11940 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11941 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
11942 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011944res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11945scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11946 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11947 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
11948 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011950res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11951 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11952 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11953 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11954 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11955 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
11956 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
11957 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
11958 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
11959 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011961res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11962 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11963 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11964 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11965 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
11966 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011968res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11969shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
11970 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11971 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11972 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11973 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11974 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
11975 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
11976 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
11977 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011979 ACL derivatives :
11980 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11981 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11982 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11983 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11984 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11985 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11986 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11987 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11988
11989res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11990shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11991 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11992 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11993 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
11994 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
11995 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011997res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11998shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11999 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
12000 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
12001 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
12002 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
12003 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
12004 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012006res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
12007shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
12008 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
12009 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
12010 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
12011 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
12012 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
12013 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010012014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012015res.ver : string
12016resp_ver : string (deprecated)
12017 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
12018 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020012019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012020 ACL derivatives :
12021 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010012022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012023set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
12024 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
12025 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
12026 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
12027 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012029 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
12030 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010012031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012032 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012034status : integer
12035 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
12036 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
12037 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012039url : string
12040 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
12041 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
12042 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
12043 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
12044 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
12045 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
12046 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012048 ACL derivatives :
12049 url : exact string match
12050 url_beg : prefix match
12051 url_dir : subdir match
12052 url_dom : domain match
12053 url_end : suffix match
12054 url_len : length match
12055 url_reg : regex match
12056 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012058url_ip : ip
12059 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
12060 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
12061 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
12062 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
12063 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
12064 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
12065 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012067url_port : integer
12068 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
12069 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
12070 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
12071 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012073urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
12074url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
12075 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
12076 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
12077 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
12078 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
12079 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
12080 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
12081 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
12082 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
12083 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012085 ACL derivatives :
12086 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
12087 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
12088 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
12089 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
12090 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
12091 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
12092 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
12093 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012094
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012096 Example :
12097 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
12098 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
12099 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
12100 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020012101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012102urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
12103 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
12104 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
12105 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020012106
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010012107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200121087.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012109---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012111Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
12112every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012113order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012114
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012115ACL name Equivalent to Usage
12116---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012117FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020012118HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012119HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
12120HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012121HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
12122HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
12123HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
12124HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
12125LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012126METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
12127METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
12128METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
12129METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
12130METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
12131METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020012132RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012133REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012134TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012135WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
12136---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010012137
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012138
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121398. Logging
12140----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012141
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012142One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
12143provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
12144very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
12145provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
12146state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012147to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012148headers.
12149
12150In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
12151about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
12152send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
12153
12154 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
12155 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
12156 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
12157 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
12158 at the termination.
12159
12160The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
12161allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
12162as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
12163while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
12164real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
12165delay.
12166
12167
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121688.1. Log levels
12169---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012170
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012171TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012172source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012173HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
12174in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
12175track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
12176syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
12177about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012178
12179
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121808.2. Log formats
12181----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012182
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012183HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090012184and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
12185slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
12186options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012187
12188 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
12189 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
12190 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
12191 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
12192 extents.
12193
12194 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
12195 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
12196 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
12197 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
12198 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
12199
12200 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
12201 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
12202 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
12203 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
12204 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
12205
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020012206 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
12207 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
12208 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
12209 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
12210
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012211 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
12212
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012213Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
12214specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
12215field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
12216servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
12217always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
12218identifier.
12219
12220Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
12221 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
12222 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
12223 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
12224 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
12225
12226
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122278.2.1. Default log format
12228-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012229
12230This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
12231as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
12232format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
12233
12234 Example :
12235 listen www
12236 mode http
12237 log global
12238 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12239
12240 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
12241 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
12242 (www/HTTP)
12243
12244 Field Format Extract from the example above
12245 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
12246 2 'Connect from' Connect from
12247 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
12248 4 'to' to
12249 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
12250 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
12251
12252Detailed fields description :
12253 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
12254 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
12255 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
12256 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
12257 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12258 and processed the connection.
12259 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
12260
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012261In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
12262"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
12263connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
12264
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012265It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
12266will eventually disappear.
12267
12268
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122698.2.2. TCP log format
12270---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012271
12272The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
12273is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
12274information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
12275counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
12276emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
12277environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
12278the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
12279sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012280specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
12281not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
12282fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
12283marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012284
12285 Example :
12286 frontend fnt
12287 mode tcp
12288 option tcplog
12289 log global
12290 default_backend bck
12291
12292 backend bck
12293 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12294
12295 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
12296 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
12297 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
12298
12299 Field Format Extract from the example above
12300 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
12301 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
12302 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
12303 4 frontend_name fnt
12304 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
12305 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
12306 7 bytes_read* 212
12307 8 termination_state --
12308 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
12309 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12310
12311Detailed fields description :
12312 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012313 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12314 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12315 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12316 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12317 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012318
12319 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012320 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12321 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12322 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012323
12324 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
12325 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
12326 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
12327 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
12328
12329 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12330 and processed the connection.
12331
12332 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12333 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12334 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
12335 applications.
12336
12337 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12338 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12339 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12340 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
12341 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
12342
12343 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12344 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12345 See "Timers" below for more details.
12346
12347 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12348 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12349 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
12350 "Timers" below for more details.
12351
12352 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012353 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012354 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12355 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12356 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12357 details.
12358
12359 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
12360 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
12361 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
12362 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
12363 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
12364
12365 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12366 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12367 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
12368 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
12369 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
12370 for more details.
12371
12372 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012373 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012374 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
12375 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
12376 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012377 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012378
12379 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12380 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12381 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12382 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12383 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12384 caused by a denial of service attack.
12385
12386 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12387 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12388 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12389 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12390 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12391 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12392 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12393 denial of service attack.
12394
12395 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12396 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12397 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12398 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12399 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12400 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12401 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12402 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
12403 be processed than on other servers.
12404
12405 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12406 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12407 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12408 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12409 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12410 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12411 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12412 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12413 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12414 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12415 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12416 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12417 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12418
12419 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12420 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12421 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12422 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12423 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12424 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12425 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12426 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12427
12428 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12429 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12430 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12431 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12432 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12433 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12434 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12435 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12436 occurs.
12437
12438
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200124398.2.3. HTTP log format
12440----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012441
12442The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
12443is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
12444the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
12445are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
12446emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
12447generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
12448"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
12449which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012450frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
12451is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012452
12453Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
12454slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
12455with a star ('*') after the field name below.
12456
12457 Example :
12458 frontend http-in
12459 mode http
12460 option httplog
12461 log global
12462 default_backend bck
12463
12464 backend static
12465 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
12466
12467 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
12468 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
12469 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012470 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012471
12472 Field Format Extract from the example above
12473 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
12474 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
12475 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
12476 4 frontend_name http-in
12477 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
12478 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
12479 7 status_code 200
12480 8 bytes_read* 2750
12481 9 captured_request_cookie -
12482 10 captured_response_cookie -
12483 11 termination_state ----
12484 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
12485 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
12486 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
12487 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
12488 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012489
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012490
12491Detailed fields description :
12492 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012493 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
12494 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
12495 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
12496 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
12497 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012498
12499 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010012500 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
12501 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
12502 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012503
12504 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
12505 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
12506 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
12507 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
12508 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
12509
12510 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
12511 and processed the connection.
12512
12513 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
12514 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
12515 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
12516
12517 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
12518 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
12519 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
12520 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
12521 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
12522 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
12523
12524 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
12525 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
12526 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
12527 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
12528 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
12529 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
12530
12531 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
12532 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
12533 See "Timers" below for more details.
12534
12535 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
12536 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
12537 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
12538 below for more details.
12539
12540 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
12541 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
12542 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
12543 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
12544 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
12545 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
12546 for more details.
12547
12548 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012549 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012550 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
12551 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
12552 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
12553 details.
12554
12555 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
12556 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
12557 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
12558
12559 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
12560 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
12561 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
12562 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
12563 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
12564 overflowing.
12565
12566 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
12567 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
12568 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
12569 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
12570 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
12571 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
12572 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
12573 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12574
12575 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
12576 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
12577 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
12578 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
12579 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
12580 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
12581 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
12582 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
12583
12584 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
12585 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
12586 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
12587 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
12588 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
12589 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
12590 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
12591
12592 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012593 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012594 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
12595 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
12596 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012597 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012598 system.
12599
12600 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
12601 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
12602 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
12603 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
12604 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
12605 caused by a denial of service attack.
12606
12607 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
12608 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
12609 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
12610 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
12611 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
12612 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
12613 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
12614 denial of service attack.
12615
12616 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
12617 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
12618 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
12619 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
12620 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
12621 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
12622 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
12623 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
12624 processed than on other servers.
12625
12626 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
12627 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
12628 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
12629 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
12630 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
12631 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
12632 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
12633 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
12634 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
12635 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
12636 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
12637 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
12638 should not be attributed to the logged server.
12639
12640 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12641 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
12642 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
12643 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
12644 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
12645 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
12646 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
12647 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
12648
12649 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
12650 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
12651 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
12652 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
12653 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
12654 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
12655 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
12656 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
12657 occurs.
12658
12659 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
12660 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
12661 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
12662 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
12663 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
12664 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
12665 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
12666 cookies" below for more details.
12667
12668 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
12669 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
12670 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
12671 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
12672 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
12673 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
12674 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
12675 and cookies" below for more details.
12676
12677 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
12678 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
12679 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
12680 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
12681 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
12682 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
12683 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
12684 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
12685
12686
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200126878.2.4. Custom log format
12688------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012689
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012690The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012691mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012692
12693HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
12694Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
12695separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
12696prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
12697
12698Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
12699variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
12700string formats ("Q").
12701
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012702If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012703as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012704less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
12705the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
12706
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012707Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012708In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010012709in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012710
12711Flags are :
12712 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012713 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012714
12715 Example:
12716
12717 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
12718 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
12719
12720At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
12721
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012722 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
12723 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012724
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012725the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012726
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012727 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012728 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012729 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012730
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012731and the default TCP format is defined this way :
12732
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012733 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012734 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
12735
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012736Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
12737
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012738 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012739 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012740 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
12741 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
12742 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012743 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
12744 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
12745 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012746 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012747 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020012748 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012749 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012750 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080012751 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012752 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
12753 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012754 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012755 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
12756 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012757 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012758 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
12759 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012760 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12761 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
12762 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012763 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012764 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
12765 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012766 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012767 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12768 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
12769 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012770 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020012771 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020012772 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
12773 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
12774 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
12775 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012776 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012777 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012778 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012779 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010012780 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012781 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012782 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
12783 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
12784 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012785 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012786 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
12787 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012788 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012789 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012790 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012791 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012792
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012793 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012794
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010012795
127968.2.5. Error log format
12797-----------------------
12798
12799When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
12800protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
12801By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
12802"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
12803will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
12804logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
12805
12806The format looks like this :
12807
12808 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
12809 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
12810 Connection error during SSL handshake
12811
12812 Field Format Extract from the example above
12813 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
12814 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
12815 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
12816 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
12817 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
12818
12819These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
12820failures.
12821
12822
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128238.3. Advanced logging options
12824-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012825
12826Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
12827just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
12828options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
12829for more information about their usage.
12830
12831
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128328.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
12833------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012834
12835It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
12836haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
12837commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
12838monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
12839ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
12840
12841 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
12842 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
12843 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
12844 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
12845
12846 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
12847 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
12848 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012849 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012850 such as other load-balancers.
12851
12852 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
12853 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
12854 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
12855
12856
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128578.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
12858----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012859
12860The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
12861what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
12862or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
12863"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
12864just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
12865log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
12866after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
12867is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
12868with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
12869with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
12870
12871
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128728.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
12873------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012874
12875Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
12876for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
12877"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
12878retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
12879raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
12880a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
12881file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
12882you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
12883"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
12884
12885
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128868.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
12887--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012888
12889Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
12890multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
12891them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
12892"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
12893logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
12894error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
12895and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
12896too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
12897useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
12898alternative.
12899
12900
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129018.4. Timing events
12902------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012903
12904Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
12905reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
12906the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
12907frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
12908mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
12909
12910 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
12911 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
12912 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
12913 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
12914 the client closes prematurely or times out.
12915
12916 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
12917 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
12918 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
12919 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
12920 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
12921
12922 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
12923 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
12924 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
12925 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
12926 connection never established.
12927
12928 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
12929 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
12930 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
12931 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
12932 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
12933 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
12934 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
12935 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
12936 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
12937 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
12938 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
12939
12940 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
12941 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
12942 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
12943 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012944 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012945
12946 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
12947
12948 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
12949 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
12950 negative.
12951
12952These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
12953protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
12954that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012955due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012956close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
12957session has been aborted on timeout.
12958
12959Most common cases :
12960
12961 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12962 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
12963 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
12964 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
12965 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
12966 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
12967 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
12968 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
12969 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020012970 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
12971 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
12972 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012973
12974 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12975 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
12976 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
12977 of ms on remote networks.
12978
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012979 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
12980 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
12981 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012982
12983 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
12984 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
12985 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
12986 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
12987 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
12988 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
12989 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
12990 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
12991 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
12992 to the server until another one is released.
12993
12994Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
12995
12996 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
12997 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
12998 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
12999
13000 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
13001 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
13002 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
13003
13004 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
13005 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
13006 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
13007 flags.
13008
13009 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
13010 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
13011 Check the session termination flags, then check the
13012 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
13013 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
13014 the client connection was maintained open.
13015
13016 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013017 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013018 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
13019 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
13020
13021
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200130228.5. Session state at disconnection
13023-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013024
13025TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
13026"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
130272-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
13028each of which has a special meaning :
13029
13030 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
13031 session to terminate :
13032
13033 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
13034
13035 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
13036 server explicitly refused it.
13037
13038 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
13039 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
13040 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
13041 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020013042 (eg: cacheable cookie).
13043
13044 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
13045 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013046
13047 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
13048 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
13049 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
13050 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
13051 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
13052
13053 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
13054 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
13055 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
13056 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
13057 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
13058
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090013059 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
13060 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
13061
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013062 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
13063 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
13064 backup connections when going up.
13065
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020013066 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
13067
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013068 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
13069 send or receive data.
13070
13071 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
13072 send or receive data.
13073
13074 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
13075 with nothing left in the buffers.
13076
13077 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
13078
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010013079 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013080 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
13081
13082 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
13083 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
13084 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
13085 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
13086 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
13087
13088 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
13089 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
13090
13091 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
13092 server (HTTP only).
13093
13094 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
13095
13096 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
13097 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
13098 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
13099
13100 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
13101 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
13102 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
13103
13104 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
13105
13106 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
13107 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
13108
13109 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
13110 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
13111 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
13112
13113 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
13114 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020013115 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
13116 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013117
13118 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
13119 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
13120 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
13121 another server.
13122
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013123 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013124 server.
13125
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013126 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
13127 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
13128 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
13129 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13130
13131 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
13132 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
13133 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
13134 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
13135
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020013136 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
13137 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
13138 "use-server" rule).
13139
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013140 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13141
13142 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
13143 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
13144
13145 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
13146
13147 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
13148 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
13149 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
13150
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013151 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
13152 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013153 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013154 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
13155 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
13156
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013157 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
13158
13159 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
13160 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
13161
13162 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
13163
13164 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
13165
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013166The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
13167was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013168helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
13169starvation, attacks, etc...
13170
13171The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
13172alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
13173easier finding and understanding.
13174
13175 Flags Reason
13176
13177 -- Normal termination.
13178
13179 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
13180 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
13181 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
13182 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
13183
13184 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
13185 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
13186 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
13187 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
13188 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
13189 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013190
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013191 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13192 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013193 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013194
13195 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
13196 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
13197 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
13198
13199 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
13200 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
13201 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
13202 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
13203 the server takes too long to respond.
13204
13205 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
13206 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
13207 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
13208 long a time to respond.
13209
13210 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
13211 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
13212 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
13213 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
13214 and the client.
13215
13216 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
13217 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
13218 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
13219 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
13220 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013221 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
13222 some browsers such as Google Chrome started to break the deployed Web
13223 infrastructure by aggressively implementing a new "pre-connect"
13224 feature, consisting in sending connections to sites recently visited
13225 without sending any request on them until the user starts to browse
13226 the site. This mechanism causes massive disruption among resource-
13227 limited servers, and causes a lot of 408 errors in HAProxy logs.
13228 Worse, some people report that sometimes the browser displays the 408
13229 error when the user expects to see the actual content (Mozilla fixed
13230 this bug in 2004, while Chrome users continue to report it in 2014),
13231 so in this case, using "errorfile 408 /dev/null" can be used as a
13232 workaround. More information on the subject is available here :
13233 https://bugzilla.mozilla.org/show_bug.cgi?id=248827
13234 https://code.google.com/p/chromium/issues/detail?id=85229
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013235
13236 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
13237 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013238 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
13239 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
13240 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
13241 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013242
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020013243 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
13244 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
13245
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013246 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013247 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
13248 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
13249 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
13250 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
13251 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
13252
13253 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
13254 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
13255 503 or 504 here.
13256
13257 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
13258 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
13259 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
13260 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
13261 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
13262
13263 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
13264 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013265 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013266 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
13267 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
13268
13269 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
13270 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
13271 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
13272 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
13273 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
13274 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
13275 between haproxy and the server.
13276
13277 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
13278 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
13279 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
13280 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
13281 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
13282 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
13283 solution is to fix the application.
13284
13285 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
13286 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
13287 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
13288 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
13289 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
13290 external attacks.
13291
13292 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
13293 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020013294 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013295 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
13296 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
13297
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013298 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
13299 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
13300 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020013301 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
13302 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013303
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013304 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
13305 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
13306 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
13307 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010013308 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
13309 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
13310 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
13311 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
13312 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013313
13314 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
13315 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
13316 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
13317 returned an HTTP 403 error.
13318
13319 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
13320 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
13321 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
13322 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
13323
13324 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
13325 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
13326 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
13327 only be solved by proper system tuning.
13328
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013329The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
13330persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
13331important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
13332re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
13333
13334 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
13335
13336 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13337 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
13338 set on a GET request.
13339
13340 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
13341 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013342 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020013343 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
13344
13345 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
13346 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
13347 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
13348
13349 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
13350 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
13351 already got a cookie.
13352
13353 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13354 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
13355 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
13356 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
13357 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
13358
13359 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
13360 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
13361 new cookie was inserted in the response.
13362
13363 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
13364 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
13365 new cookie was inserted in the response.
13366
13367 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
13368 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
13369
13370 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
13371 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
13372 then advertised in the response.
13373
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013374
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133758.6. Non-printable characters
13376-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013377
13378In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
13379consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
13380converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
13381prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
13382being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
13383escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
13384is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
13385'}' when logging headers.
13386
13387Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
13388issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
13389containing spaces is "User-Agent".
13390
13391Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
13392the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
13393performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
13394
13395
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200133968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
13397---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013398
13399Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
13400achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013401section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013402cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
13403the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
13404the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013405locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013406not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
13407user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
13408a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
13409wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
13410
13411 Examples :
13412 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
13413 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
13414
13415 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
13416 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
13417
13418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134198.8. Capturing HTTP headers
13420---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013421
13422Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
13423proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
13424the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
13425server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
13426
13427Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
13428response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013429section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013430
13431It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013432time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
13433appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013434are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
13435and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
13436follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
13437request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
13438in the logs.
13439
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020013440As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
13441frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
13442an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
13443
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013444 Example :
13445 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
13446 listen proxy-out
13447 mode http
13448 option httplog
13449 option logasap
13450 log global
13451 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
13452
13453 # log the name of the virtual server
13454 capture request header Host len 20
13455
13456 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
13457 capture request header Content-Length len 10
13458
13459 # log the beginning of the referrer
13460 capture request header Referer len 20
13461
13462 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
13463 capture response header Server len 20
13464
13465 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
13466 capture response header Content-Length len 10
13467
13468 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
13469 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
13470
13471 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
13472 capture response header Via len 20
13473
13474 # log the URL location during a redirection
13475 capture response header Location len 20
13476
13477 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
13478 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
13479 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13480 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
13481 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
13482
13483 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13484 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13485 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13486 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013487 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013488
13489 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
13490 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
13491 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
13492 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
13493 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013494 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013495
13496
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134978.9. Examples of logs
13498---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013499
13500These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
13501them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
13502reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
13503
13504 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
13505 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13506 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13507
13508 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
13509 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
13510
13511 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
13512 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
13513 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
13514
13515 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
13516 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
13517
13518 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
13519 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
13520 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
13521
13522 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013523 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013524 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
13525 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
13526
13527 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
13528 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
13529 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
13530
13531 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
13532 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020013533 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013534 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
13535 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
13536 to return the 502 and not the server.
13537
13538 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013539 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013540
13541 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
13542 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
13543 Nothing was sent to any server.
13544
13545 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
13546 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
13547
13548 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
13549 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
13550 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
13551 send a 408 return code to the client.
13552
13553 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
13554 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
13555
13556 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
13557 5 seconds ("c----").
13558
13559 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
13560 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013561 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013562
13563 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013564 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010013565 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
13566 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
13567 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
13568 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
13569 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013570
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013571
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135729. Statistics and monitoring
13573----------------------------
13574
13575It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
13576mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
13577CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
13578Unix socket.
13579
13580
135819.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013582---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010013583
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013584The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
Willy Tarreaua3310dc2014-06-16 15:43:21 +020013585page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow. The first line
13586begins with a sharp ('#') and has one word per comma-delimited field which
13587represents the title of the column. All other lines starting at the second one
13588use a classical CSV format using a comma as the delimiter, and the double quote
13589('"') as an optional text delimiter, but only if the enclosed text is ambiguous
13590(if it contains a quote or a comma). The double-quote character ('"') in the
13591text is doubled ('""'), which is the format that most tools recognize. Please
13592do not insert any column before these ones in order not to break tools which
13593use hard-coded column positions.
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010013594
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013595In brackets after each field name are the types which may have a value for
13596that field. The types are L (Listeners), F (Frontends), B (Backends), and
13597S (Servers).
13598
13599 0. pxname [LFBS]: proxy name
13600 1. svname [LFBS]: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend,
13601 any name for server/listener)
13602 2. qcur [..BS]: current queued requests. For the backend this reports the
13603 number queued without a server assigned.
13604 3. qmax [..BS]: max value of qcur
13605 4. scur [LFBS]: current sessions
13606 5. smax [LFBS]: max sessions
13607 6. slim [LFBS]: configured session limit
13608 7. stot [LFBS]: cumulative number of connections
13609 8. bin [LFBS]: bytes in
13610 9. bout [LFBS]: bytes out
13611 10. dreq [LFB.]: requests denied because of security concerns.
13612 - For tcp this is because of a matched tcp-request content rule.
13613 - For http this is because of a matched http-request or tarpit rule.
13614 11. dresp [LFBS]: responses denied because of security concerns.
13615 - For http this is because of a matched http-request rule, or
13616 "option checkcache".
13617 12. ereq [LF..]: request errors. Some of the possible causes are:
13618 - early termination from the client, before the request has been sent.
13619 - read error from the client
13620 - client timeout
13621 - client closed connection
13622 - various bad requests from the client.
13623 - request was tarpitted.
13624 13. econ [..BS]: number of requests that encountered an error trying to
13625 connect to a backend server. The backend stat is the sum of the stat
13626 for all servers of that backend, plus any connection errors not
13627 associated with a particular server (such as the backend having no
13628 active servers).
13629 14. eresp [..BS]: response errors. srv_abrt will be counted here also.
13630 Some other errors are:
13631 - write error on the client socket (won't be counted for the server stat)
13632 - failure applying filters to the response.
13633 15. wretr [..BS]: number of times a connection to a server was retried.
13634 16. wredis [..BS]: number of times a request was redispatched to another
13635 server. The server value counts the number of times that server was
13636 switched away from.
13637 17. status [LFBS]: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
13638 18. weight [..BS]: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
13639 19. act [..BS]: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
13640 20. bck [..BS]: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
13641 21. chkfail [...S]: number of failed checks. (Only counts checks failed when
13642 the server is up.)
13643 22. chkdown [..BS]: number of UP->DOWN transitions. The backend counter counts
13644 transitions to the whole backend being down, rather than the sum of the
13645 counters for each server.
13646 23. lastchg [..BS]: number of seconds since the last UP<->DOWN transition
13647 24. downtime [..BS]: total downtime (in seconds). The value for the backend
13648 is the downtime for the whole backend, not the sum of the server downtime.
13649 25. qlimit [...S]: configured maxqueue for the server, or nothing in the
13650 value is 0 (default, meaning no limit)
13651 26. pid [LFBS]: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
13652 27. iid [LFBS]: unique proxy id
13653 28. sid [L..S]: server id (unique inside a proxy)
13654 29. throttle [...S]: current throttle percentage for the server, when
13655 slowstart is active, or no value if not in slowstart.
13656 30. lbtot [..BS]: total number of times a server was selected, either for new
13657 sessions, or when re-dispatching. The server counter is the number
13658 of times that server was selected.
13659 31. tracked [...S]: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled.
13660 32. type [LFBS]: (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket/listener)
13661 33. rate [.FBS]: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
13662 34. rate_lim [.F..]: configured limit on new sessions per second
13663 35. rate_max [.FBS]: max number of new sessions per second
13664 36. check_status [...S]: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013665 UNK -> unknown
13666 INI -> initializing
13667 SOCKERR -> socket error
13668 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
13669 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
13670 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
13671 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
13672 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
13673 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
13674 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
13675 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
13676 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
13677 disable-on-404
13678 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
13679 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
13680 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
James Westbyebe62d62014-07-08 10:14:57 -040013681 37. check_code [...S]: layer5-7 code, if available
13682 38. check_duration [...S]: time in ms took to finish last health check
13683 39. hrsp_1xx [.FBS]: http responses with 1xx code
13684 40. hrsp_2xx [.FBS]: http responses with 2xx code
13685 41. hrsp_3xx [.FBS]: http responses with 3xx code
13686 42. hrsp_4xx [.FBS]: http responses with 4xx code
13687 43. hrsp_5xx [.FBS]: http responses with 5xx code
13688 44. hrsp_other [.FBS]: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
13689 45. hanafail [...S]: failed health checks details
13690 46. req_rate [.F..]: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
13691 47. req_rate_max [.F..]: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
13692 48. req_tot [.F..]: total number of HTTP requests received
13693 49. cli_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the client
13694 50. srv_abrt [..BS]: number of data transfers aborted by the server
13695 (inc. in eresp)
13696 51. comp_in [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
13697 52. comp_out [.FB.]: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
13698 53. comp_byp [.FB.]: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor
13699 (CPU/BW limit)
13700 54. comp_rsp [.FB.]: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
13701 55. lastsess [..BS]: number of seconds since last session assigned to
13702 server/backend
13703 56. last_chk [...S]: last health check contents or textual error
13704 57. last_agt [...S]: last agent check contents or textual error
13705 58. qtime [..BS]: the average queue time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13706 59. ctime [..BS]: the average connect time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13707 60. rtime [..BS]: the average response time in ms over the 1024 last requests
13708 (0 for TCP)
13709 61. ttime [..BS]: the average total session time in ms over the 1024 last
13710 requests
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013711
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013712
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137139.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013714-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013715
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013716The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
13717necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
13718A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
13719issuing commands by hand :
13720
13721 global
13722 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13723 stats timeout 2m
13724
13725It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
13726the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
13727never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
13728situations :
13729
13730 global
13731 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
13732 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
13733 stats timeout 2m
13734
13735To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
13736swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
13737to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
13738syntaxes we'll use are the following :
13739
13740 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
13741 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
13742
13743The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
13744script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
13745for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
13746
13747The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
13748that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
13749editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
13750(eg: watch a counter).
13751
13752The socket supports two operation modes :
13753 - interactive
13754 - non-interactive
13755
13756The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
13757this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
13758sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
13759mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
13760commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
13761example :
13762
13763 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
13764
13765The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
13766entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
13767for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
13768sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
13769"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
13770after processing the last command of the same line.
13771
13772For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
13773"prompt" command :
13774
13775 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
13776 prompt
13777 > show info
13778 ...
13779 >
13780
13781Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
13782delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
13783that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
13784parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013785
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013786It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
13787on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
13788own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013789
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013790The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
13791If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
13792all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
13793it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
13794
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013795add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013796 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
13797 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
13798 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
13799 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013800
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013801add map <map> <key> <value>
13802 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
13803 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013804 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
13805 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
13806 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013807
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013808clear counters
13809 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
13810 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
13811 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
13812 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
13813 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13814
13815clear counters all
13816 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
13817 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
13818 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
13819
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013820clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013821 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
13822 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
13823 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013824
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013825clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013826 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
13827 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
13828 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013829
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013830clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
13831 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
13832
13833 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
13834 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
13835 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
13836 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
13837 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
13838 later after the session ends is usual enough.
13839
13840 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
13841
13842 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
13843 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
13844 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
13845 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
13846 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
13847 the ACLs :
13848
13849 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13850 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13851 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13852 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13853 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13854 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13855
13856 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013857 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
13858 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013859
13860 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013861 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013862 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013863 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13864 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13865 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13866 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013867
13868 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13869
13870 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013871 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013872 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13873 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013874 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13875 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13876 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013877
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013878del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
13879 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013880 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
13881 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13882 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
13883 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013884
13885del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013886 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013887 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
13888 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13889 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
13890 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013891
13892disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013893 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
13894
13895 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
13896 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
13897 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
13898 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
13899 re-enabled using enable agent.
13900
13901 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
13902 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
13903 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
13904 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
13905 otherwise unchanged.
13906
13907 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
13908 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
13909 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
13910
13911 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13912 level "admin".
13913
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013914disable frontend <frontend>
13915 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
13916 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
13917 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
13918 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
13919 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
13920 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
13921 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
13922 on the stats page.
13923
13924 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13925 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13926
13927 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13928 level "admin".
13929
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013930disable health <backend>/<server>
13931 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
13932 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
13933 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
13934 agent check forces it down.
13935
13936 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13937 level "admin".
13938
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013939disable server <backend>/<server>
13940 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
13941 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
13942 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
13943 during the maintenance.
13944
13945 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
13946 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
13947
13948 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013949 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013950
13951 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13952 level "admin".
13953
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013954enable agent <backend>/<server>
13955 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
13956
13957 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
13958 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
13959
13960 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13961 level "admin".
13962
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013963enable frontend <frontend>
13964 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
13965 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
13966 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
13967 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
13968 which was disabled.
13969
13970 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13971 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13972
13973 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13974 level "admin".
13975
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013976enable health <backend>/<server>
13977 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
13978 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
13979
13980 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13981 level "admin".
13982
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013983enable server <backend>/<server>
13984 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
13985 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
13986
13987 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013988 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013989
13990 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13991 level "admin".
13992
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013993get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013994get acl <acl> <value>
13995 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
13996 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
13997 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
13998 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
13999 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010014000
14001 The first two words are:
14002
14003 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
14004 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
14005 "dom", "end" or "reg".
14006
14007 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
14008
14009 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
14010
14011 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
14012
14013 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
14014 interpretation of the case.
14015
14016 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
14017 useful with regular expressions.
14018
14019 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
14020 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
14021
14022 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
14023 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
14024 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
14025
14026 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
14027
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014028get weight <backend>/<server>
14029 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
14030 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
14031 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
14032 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
14033 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020014034 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014035
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014036help
14037 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
14038 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010014039
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014040prompt
14041 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
14042 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
14043 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
14044 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
14045 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
14046 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
14047 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
14048 command.
14049
14050quit
14051 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014052
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014053set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014054 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
14055 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
14056 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014057
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020014058set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020014059 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
14060 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
14061 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
14062 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
14063 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020014064 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
14065 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14066
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020014067set maxconn global <maxconn>
14068 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
14069 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
14070 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
14071 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
14072 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
14073 setting.
14074
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020014075set rate-limit connections global <value>
14076 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
14077 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14078 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14079 is passed in number of connections per second.
14080
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014081set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
14082 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
14083 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010014084 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
14085 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010014086
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020014087set rate-limit sessions global <value>
14088 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
14089 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14090 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14091 is passed in number of sessions per second.
14092
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020014093set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
14094 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
14095 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
14096 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
14097 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
14098 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
14099
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020014100set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
14101 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14102 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
14103 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14104
14105set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
14106 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
14107 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
14108 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
14109
14110set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
14111 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
14112 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
14113 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
14114 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
14115 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
14116 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
14117 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
14118 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
14119
14120set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
14121 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
14122 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
14123
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020014124set ssl ocsp-response <response>
14125 This command is used to update an OCSP Response for a certificate (see "crt"
14126 on "bind" lines). Same controls are performed as during the initial loading of
14127 the response. The <response> must be passed as a base64 encoded string of the
14128 DER encoded response from the OCSP server.
14129
14130 Example:
14131 openssl ocsp -issuer issuer.pem -cert server.pem \
14132 -host ocsp.issuer.com:80 -respout resp.der
14133 echo "set ssl ocsp-response $(base64 -w 10000 resp.der)" | \
14134 socat stdio /var/run/haproxy.stat
14135
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014136set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014137 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
14138 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
14139 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
14140 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020014141 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
14142 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020014143
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014144set timeout cli <delay>
14145 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
14146 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
14147 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
14148
14149set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
14150 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
14151 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090014152 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
14153 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
14154 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
14155 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
14156 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
14157 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
14158 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
14159 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
14160 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
14161 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
14162 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
14163 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
14164 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014165
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014166show errors [<iid>]
14167 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
14168 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014169 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
14170 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
14171 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014172
14173 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
14174 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
14175 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
14176 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
14177 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
14178 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
14179 are reported too.
14180
14181 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
14182 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
14183 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
14184 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
14185 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
14186 code.
14187
14188 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
14189 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
14190 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
14191 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
14192 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
14193 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
14194 line.
14195
14196 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014197 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
14198 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014199 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
14200 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
14201
14202 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
14203 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
14204 00038 Location: blah\r\n
14205 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
14206 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
14207 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
14208 00204+ minal\r\n
14209 00211 \r\n
14210
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014211 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010014212 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
14213 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
14214 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
14215 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
14216 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
14217 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010014218
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014219show info
14220 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
14221
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014222show map [<map>]
14223 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014224 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
14225 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
14226 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
14227 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
14228 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
14229 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010014230
14231show acl [<acl>]
14232 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010014233 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
14234 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
14235 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
14236 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
14237 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010014238
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010014239show pools
14240 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
14241 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
14242 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
14243 the pools.
14244
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014245show sess
14246 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020014247 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
14248 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
14249
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010014250show sess <id>
14251 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
14252 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14253 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
14254 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
14255 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Olivierce31e6e2014-09-05 18:49:10 +020014256 freely evolve depending on demands. You may find a description of all fields
14257 returned in src/dumpstats.c
14258
14259 The special id "all" dumps the states of all sessions, which must be avoided
14260 as much as possible as it is highly CPU intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014261
14262show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
14263 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
14264 possible to dump only selected items :
14265 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
14266 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
14267 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
14268 for example:
14269 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
14270 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
14271 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
14272
14273 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014274 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
14275 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014276 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
14277 Release_date: 2009/09/23
14278 Nbproc: 1
14279 Process_num: 1
14280 (...)
14281
14282 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
14283 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
14284 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
14285 (...)
14286 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
14287
14288 $
14289
14290 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
14291 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
14292 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
14293 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014294 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020014295
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014296show table
14297 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
14298 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
14299 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
14300 entries currently in use.
14301
14302 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014303 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014304 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
14305 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014306
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014307show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014308 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
14309 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
14310 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014311 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
14312
14313 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
14314 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
14315 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
14316 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
14317 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
14318
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014319 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
14320 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
14321 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
14322 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
14323 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
14324 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
14325
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090014326
14327 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090014328 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
14329 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014330
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014331 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014332 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014333 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014334 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
14335 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
14336 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14337 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014338
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014339 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014340 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014341 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14342 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014343
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014344 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
14345 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014346 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014347 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14348 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014349
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014350 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
14351 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090014352 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090014353 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
14354 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
14355
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014356 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
14357 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
14358 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
14359 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
14360 time goes, the average event rate drops.
14361
14362 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
14363 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
14364 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020014365 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
14366 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020014367 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
14368 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020014369
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020014370shutdown frontend <frontend>
14371 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
14372 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
14373 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
14374 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
14375 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
14376 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
14377 once it is terminated.
14378
14379 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
14380 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
14381
14382 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
14383 level "admin".
14384
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020014385shutdown session <id>
14386 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
14387 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
14388 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
14389 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
14390 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
14391 flag in the logs.
14392
Cyril Bontée63a1eb2014-07-12 18:22:42 +020014393shutdown sessions server <backend>/<server>
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020014394 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
14395 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
14396 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
14397 'K' flag in the logs.
14398
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014399/*
14400 * Local variables:
14401 * fill-column: 79
14402 * End:
14403 */